blob: f3e6aa147b43c2cd4fe4b9a5521f82db1b219cd2 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200675 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200676 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200677 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100678 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200679 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200680 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100681 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100682 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100683 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.session-timeout
685 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200686 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100687 - tune.maxaccept
688 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200689 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200690 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200691 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.rcvbuf.client
693 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100694 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200695 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.sndbuf.client
697 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100698 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100699 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200700 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100701 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200702 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200703 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100704 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200705 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100706 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200707 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
708 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
709 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100710 - tune.zlib.memlevel
711 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713 * Debugging
714 - debug
715 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200716 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717
718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720------------------------------------
721
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722ca-base <dir>
723 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100724 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
725 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
726 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728chroot <jail dir>
729 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
730 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
731 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
732 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
733 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100734 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100735
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
737 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
738 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
739 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
740 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
741 set. These sets have the format
742
743 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
744
745 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
748 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100749 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
750 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
756 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
757 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
758 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100759
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100760 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
761 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
762 on the machine's word size.
763
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100764 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
766 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
767 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
768 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
769 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
770 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771
772 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
774
775 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
776 # first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
779 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
780 # word size.
781
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
789 # and so on.
790 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100794 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100795 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
796 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
797 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
798
799 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
800 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
802
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100803 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
804 # and a thread range.
805 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
808
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200809crt-base <dir>
810 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100811 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
812 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200813
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814daemon
815 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
816 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100817 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
818 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820deviceatlas-json-file <path>
821 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100822 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823
824deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
827
828deviceatlas-separator <char>
829 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
830 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
831
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100832deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200833 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
834 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
835 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100836
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900837external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100838 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
839 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100840 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
841 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
842 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
843 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
844 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846gid <number>
847 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
848 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
849 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100850 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
851 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100853
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100854group <group name>
855 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
856 See also "gid" and "user".
857
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100858hard-stop-after <time>
859 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
860
861 Arguments :
862 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
863 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
864 SIGUSR1 signal.
865
866 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
867 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
868 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
869
870 Example:
871 global
872 hard-stop-after 30s
873
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200874h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
875 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
876 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
877 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
878 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500879 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
881 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
882 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
883 specified in a proxy.
884
885 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
886 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
887 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
888 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
889 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
890 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
891 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
892
893 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
894 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
895 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
896 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
897 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
898
899 Example:
900 global
901 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
902
903 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
904 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
905
906h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
907 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
908 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
909 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
910 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
911 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
912 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
913 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
914 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
915
916 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
917 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
918 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
919
920 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
921 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
922
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100923insecure-fork-wanted
924 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
925 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
926 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
927 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
928 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
929 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
930 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
931 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
932 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
933 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
934 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
935 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
936 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
937 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
938 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
939 disable it.
940
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100941insecure-setuid-wanted
942 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
943 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
944 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
945 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
946 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
947 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
948 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
949 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
950 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
951 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
952 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
953 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
954 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
955 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
956
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100957issuers-chain-path <dir>
958 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
959 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
960 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
961 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
962 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
963 "issuers-chain-path".
964 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
965 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
966 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
967 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
968 will share the chain in memory.
969
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200970log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
971 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100972 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100973 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100974 configured with "log global".
975
976 <address> can be one of:
977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100978 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100979 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
980 port).
981
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100982 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
983 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
984 port).
985
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100986 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100987 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
988 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100990
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100991 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
992 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
993 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
994 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
995 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
996 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
997 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
998 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
999 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1000 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1001 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1002 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1003 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1004 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001005 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1006 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001007
1008 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1009 "fd@2", see above.
1010
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001011 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1012 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1013 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1014 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1015 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1016
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001017 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1018 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001019
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001020 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1021 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1022 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1023 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1024 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1025 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1026 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1027 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1028 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1029 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001030 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1031 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001033 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1034 one of the following :
1035
1036 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1037 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1038
1039 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1040 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1041
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001042 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1043 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1044 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1045 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1046 logger consumes.
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1049 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1050 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1051 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1052
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001053 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1054 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1055 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1056 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1057 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1058
1059 <sample_size>
1060 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1061 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1062 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1063 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1064 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1065
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001066 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001068 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1069 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1070 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1071
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001072 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1073 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1074 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1075 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001078 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1079 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1080 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1081 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1082 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1083 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001085 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001087log-send-hostname [<string>]
1088 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1089 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1090 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1091 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1092 the logs.
1093
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001094log-tag <string>
1095 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1096 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1097 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001098 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001099
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100lua-load <file>
1101 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1102 used multiple times.
1103
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1105 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1106 variable.
1107 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1108 to "path".
1109
1110 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1111 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1112 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1113 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1114 will be checked earlier.
1115
1116 As an example by specifying the following path:
1117
1118 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1120
1121 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1122 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1124 paths if that does not exist either.
1125
1126 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1127 documentation.
1128
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001129master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001130 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1131 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1132 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001134 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1135 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001136 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1137 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1138 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1139 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1140 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001141
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001142 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001144mworker-max-reloads <number>
1145 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001146 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001147 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1148 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1149 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151nbproc <number>
1152 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1153 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1154 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001155 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1156 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001157 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1158 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001160nbthread <number>
1161 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001162 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1163 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1164 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1165 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1166 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1168 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1169 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1170 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1171 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1172 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1173 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001174
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001176 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1178 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1179
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001180presetenv <name> <value>
1181 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1182 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1183 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1184 and "unsetenv".
1185
1186resetenv [<name> ...]
1187 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1188 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1189 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1190 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1191 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1192 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1193 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1194 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1195
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001196stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001197 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1198 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1199 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1200 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1201 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1202 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001203 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001204 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1205 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1206 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1207 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001208
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001209server-state-base <directory>
1210 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001211 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1212 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001213
1214server-state-file <file>
1215 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1216 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1217 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1218 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1219 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1220 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1221 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1222 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001223 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1224 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001225
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001226setenv <name> <value>
1227 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1228 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1229 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1230 and "unsetenv".
1231
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001232set-dumpable
1233 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001234 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1235 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1236 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1237 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1238 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1239 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1240 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1241 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1242 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1243 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1244 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1245 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1246 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1247 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1248 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1249 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1250 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001251
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001252ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1254 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001255 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001256 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001257 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1258 information and recommendations see e.g.
1259 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1260 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1261 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1262 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001263
1264ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1266 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1267 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1268 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1269 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001270 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1271 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1272 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001273 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001274
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001275ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1277 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1278 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1279 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1280 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1281
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001282ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1284 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1285 keyword to see available options.
1286
1287 Example:
1288 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001289 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001291ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1293 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001294 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001295 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1297 information and recommendations see e.g.
1298 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1299 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1300 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1301 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1302 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1307 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1308 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1309 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1313 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1318 keyword to see available options.
1319
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001320ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1322 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1323 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001324 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001325 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001326 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1327 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1328 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1329 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001330 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1331 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1332 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1333
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001334ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001335 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1336 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1337
1338 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1339 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1340 optimize the startup time.
1341
1342 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1343 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1344 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1345
1346 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001347 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001348
1349 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1350 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1351 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1352 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1353 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1354 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001355 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001356 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1357
1358 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1359
1360 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1361
1362 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1363 not provided in the PEM file.
1364
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001365 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1366 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1367
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001368 The default behavior is "all".
1369
1370 Example:
1371 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1372 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1373 ssl-load-extra-files none
1374
1375 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1376
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001377ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1378 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1379 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1380 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1381
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001382ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1383 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1384 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1385 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1386 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1387 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1388 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1389 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1390 bits does not need it.
1391
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001392stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1393 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1394 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1395 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001396 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001397 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001398
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001399 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1400 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1401 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001402
1403stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1404 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1405 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001406 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001407
1408stats maxconn <connections>
1409 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1410 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1411
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412uid <number>
1413 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1414 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1415 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1416 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1417
1418ulimit-n <number>
1419 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1420 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1421 option.
1422
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001423unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1424 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1425
1426 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1427 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1428 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1429 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1430 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1431 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1432 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1433 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1434 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1435 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1436
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001437unsetenv [<name> ...]
1438 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1439 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1440 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1441 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1442 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1443 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1444 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1445
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446user <user name>
1447 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1448 See also "uid" and "group".
1449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001450node <name>
1451 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1452
1453 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1454 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1455 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1456 traffic.
1457
1458description <text>
1459 Add a text that describes the instance.
1460
1461 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1462 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1463 "<" and ">" characters.
1464
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146551degrees-data-file <file path>
1466 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001467 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001468
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001469 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001470 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1471
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001473 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1474 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1475 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1476
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001477 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001478 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1479
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001481 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1482 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1483
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
148751degrees-cache-size <number>
1488 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1489 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1490 By default, this cache is disabled.
1491
1492 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1494
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001495wurfl-data-file <file path>
1496 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1497 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1498
1499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1500 with USE_WURFL=1.
1501
1502wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1503 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1504 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1505 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1506
1507 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1508
1509 Valid WURFL properties are:
1510 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1511
1512 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1513 device.
1514
1515 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1516 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1517
1518 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1519 particular web request.
1520
1521 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1522 used Libwurfl API version.
1523
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001524 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1525 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1526
1527 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1528 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1529
1530 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1531
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001532 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1533 with USE_WURFL=1.
1534
1535wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1536 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1537 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1538
1539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1540 with USE_WURFL=1.
1541
1542wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1543 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1544 thus before the chroot.
1545
1546 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1547 with USE_WURFL=1.
1548
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001549wurfl-cache-size <size>
1550 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1551 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001552 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001553 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001554
1555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1556 with USE_WURFL=1.
1557
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001558strict-limits
1559 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1560 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1561 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1562 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1563 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1564 keyword.
1565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567-----------------------
1568
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001569busy-polling
1570 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1571 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1572 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1573 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1574 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1575 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1576 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1577 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1578 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1579 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1580 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1581 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1582 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1583 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1584 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1585 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1586 "poll" pollers.
1587
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001588 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1589 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1590 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1591
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001592max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1593 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1594 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1595 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1596 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1597 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1598 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1599 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1600 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001602maxconn <number>
1603 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1604 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1605 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001606 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1607 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1608 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1609 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001610 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1611 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1612 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1613 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1614 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1615 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001617maxconnrate <number>
1618 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1619 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1620 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1621 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1622 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1623 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1624 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1625 fairness.
1626
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001627maxcomprate <number>
1628 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001629 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001630 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1631 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1632 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001633 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001634 default value.
1635
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001636maxcompcpuusage <number>
1637 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1638 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1639 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1640 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1641 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1642 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1643 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1644 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1645
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001646maxpipes <number>
1647 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1648 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1649 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1650 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1651 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1652 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1653
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001654maxsessrate <number>
1655 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1656 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1657 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1658 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1659 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1660 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1661 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1662 fairness.
1663
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001664maxsslconn <number>
1665 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1666 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1667 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1668 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1669 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1670 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1671 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001672 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1673 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1674 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1675 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1676 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1677 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1678 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001679
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001680maxsslrate <number>
1681 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1682 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1683 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1684 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1685 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1686 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1687 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1688 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1689 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1690 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1691
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001692maxzlibmem <number>
1693 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1694 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1695 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001696 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1697 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1698 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700noepoll
1701 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1702 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001703 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704
1705nokqueue
1706 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1707 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1708 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1709
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001710noevports
1711 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1712 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1713 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1714 also "nopoll".
1715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001716nopoll
1717 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1718 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001720 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1721 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001723nosplice
1724 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001725 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001726 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001728 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1729 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1730 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1731 "option splice-response".
1732
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001733nogetaddrinfo
1734 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1735 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1736
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001737noreuseport
1738 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1739 command line argument "-dR".
1740
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001741profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1742 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1743 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1744 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1745 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001746 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001747 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1748 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1749 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1750 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1751
1752 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1753 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1754 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1755 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1756 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001757 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1758 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1759 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1760 CLI.
1761
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001762spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001763 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1764 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1765 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1766 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1767 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1768 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001771 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001772 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001773 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1774 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1775 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1776 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1777 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001778 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1779 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001780 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1781 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1782 openssl configuration file uses:
1783 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1784
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001785ssl-mode-async
1786 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001787 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001788 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1789 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1790 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001791 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001792 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001793
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001794tune.buffers.limit <number>
1795 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1796 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1797 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1798 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1799 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001800 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001801 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1802 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1803 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1804 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1805 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1806 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1807 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1808 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1809 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1810
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001811tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1812 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1813 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1814 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1815 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001817tune.bufsize <number>
1818 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1819 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1820 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1821 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1822 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1823 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1824 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001825 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1826 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1827 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001828 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001829 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1830 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1831 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001832
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001833tune.chksize <number>
1834 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1835 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1836 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1837 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1838 checks whenever possible.
1839
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001840tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1841 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1842 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1843 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1844 this value. The default value is 1.
1845
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001846tune.fail-alloc
1847 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1848 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1849 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1850 gracefully.
1851
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001852tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1853 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1854 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1855 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1856 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1857 change it.
1858
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001859tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1860 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1862 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001863 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1864 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1865 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1866 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1867 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1868
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001869tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1870 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1871 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1872 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1873 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1874 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1875 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1876 recommended not to change this value.
1877
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001878tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1879 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1880 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1881 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1882 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1883 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1884 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1885 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1886
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001887tune.http.cookielen <number>
1888 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1889 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1890 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1891 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1892 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1893 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1894 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1895 to change this value.
1896
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001897tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1899 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001900 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001901 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001902 configuration directives too.
1903 The default value is 1024.
1904
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001905tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1906 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1907 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1908 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1909 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1910 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1911 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001912 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1913 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1914 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001915
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001916tune.idletimer <timeout>
1917 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1918 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1919 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1920 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1921 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1922 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001923 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001924 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001925 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1926
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001927tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1928 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1929 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1930 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1931 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1932 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1933 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1934 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1935 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1936 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1937
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001938tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1939 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001940 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001941 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1942 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001944 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1945 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1946
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001947tune.lua.maxmem
1948 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1949 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1950 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1951 memory.
1952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001953tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1954 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001955 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1956 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001957 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001958
1959tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1960 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1961 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1962 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1963 check servers.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001965tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1966 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1967 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1968 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001970
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001971tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001972 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1973 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1974 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1975 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1976 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1977 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1978 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1979 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1980 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1981 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001982
1983tune.maxpollevents <number>
1984 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1985 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1986 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1987 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1988 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1989
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001990tune.maxrewrite <number>
1991 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1992 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1993 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1994 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1995 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1996 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1997 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1998 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1999 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2000 bufsize.
2001
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002002tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2003 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2004 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2005 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2006 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2007 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2008 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2009 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2010 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2011 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002012 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2013 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002014 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2015 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2016 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2017 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2018 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2019 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2020 setting this parameter to 0.
2021
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002022tune.pipesize <number>
2023 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2024 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2025 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2026 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2027 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2028 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2029
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002030tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2031 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2032 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2033 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2034 default is 20.
2035
2036tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2037 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2038 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2039 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2040 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2041 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2042 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002043 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002044
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002045tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2046tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2047 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2048 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2049 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002050 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002051 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002052 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2053 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2054
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002055tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002056 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002057 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2058 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2059 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2060 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2061
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002062tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002063 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002064 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2065 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2066
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002067tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2068tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2069 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2070 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2071 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002072 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002074 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2075 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2076 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2077 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2078 notifying haproxy again.
2079
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002080tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002081 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2082 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2083 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002084 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002085 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002087 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2088 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2089 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002090 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2091 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002092
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002093tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002094 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002095 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2096 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2097 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2098 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2099 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2100
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002101tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2102 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002103 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002104 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2105 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2106 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2107 being used for too long.
2108
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002109tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2110 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2111 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2112 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2113 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2114 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2115 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2116 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2117 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2118 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2119 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002120 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002121 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002122
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002123tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2124 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2125 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2126 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2127 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2128 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2129 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2130 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002131 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2132 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002133
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002134tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2135 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2136 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2137 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2138 1000 entries.
2139
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002140tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2141 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2142 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2143 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2144
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002145tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002146tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002147tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2148tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002150 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2151 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2152 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2153 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2154 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2155 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2156 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2157 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002158
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002159 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2160 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2161 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2162 all available space is consumed.
2163 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2164 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2165 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002166
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002167tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2168 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002169 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002170 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002171 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002172 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2173
2174tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2175 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2176 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002177 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2178 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021803.3. Debugging
2181--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002182
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002183debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002184 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2185 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2186 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2187 system startup.
2188
2189quiet
2190 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2191 line argument "-q".
2192
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002193zero-warning
2194 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2195 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2196 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2197 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2198 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2199 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2200
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022023.4. Userlists
2203--------------
2204It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2205http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2206it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2207
2208userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002209 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002210 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2211
2212group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002213 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002214 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2215 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2216
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002217user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2218 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002219 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2220 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002221 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2222 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2223 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2224 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002226 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2227 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2228 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2229 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2230 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2231 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2232 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2233 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2234 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002235
2236 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002237 userlist L1
2238 group G1 users tiger,scott
2239 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002241 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2242 user scott insecure-password elgato
2243 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002245 userlist L2
2246 group G1
2247 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002248
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002249 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2250 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2251 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002252
2253 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002255
22563.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002257----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002258It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2259several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2260instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2261values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2262automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2263In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2264using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2265tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2266reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2267Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2268that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2269each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002270
2271peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002272 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002273 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2274
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002275bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2276 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2277 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2278
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002279disabled
2280 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2281 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2282 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2283
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002284default-bind [param*]
2285 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2286
2287default-server [param*]
2288 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2289
2290 Arguments:
2291 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2292 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2293 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2294 details.
2295
2296
2297 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2298
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002299enable
2300 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2301
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002302log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2303 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2304 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2305 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2306 more details.
2307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002309 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2310 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2311 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2312 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2313 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2314 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2315
2316 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2317 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2318
2319 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2320 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2321 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2322 across all peers.
2323
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002324 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2325 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002326
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002327 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2328 "server" keyword explanation below).
2329
2330server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002331 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002332 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2333 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2334 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2335 of this "peers" section).
2336 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2337
2338
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002339 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002340 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002341 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002342 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2343 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2344 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002345
2346 backend mybackend
2347 mode tcp
2348 balance roundrobin
2349 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2350 stick on src
2351
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002352 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2353 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002354
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355 Example:
2356 peers mypeers
2357 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2358 default-server ssl verify none
2359 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2360 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002362
2363table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2364 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2365
2366 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2367 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002368 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002369 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2370 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2371 "stick-table" keyword).
2372
2373 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2374 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2375 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2376 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2377 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2378 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2379 of the stick-table name as follows:
2380
2381 peers mypeers
2382 peer A ...
2383 peer B ...
2384 table t1 ...
2385
2386 frontend fe1
2387 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2388
2389 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2390 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2391
2392 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2393 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2394 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2395 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2396 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2397 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2398 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2399
2400 peers mypeers
2401 peer A ...
2402 peer B ...
2403 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2404
2405 backend t1
2406 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2407
2408 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2409 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2410 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2411
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024123.6. Mailers
2413------------
2414It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2415If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2416in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2417
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002418mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2420 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2421
2422mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2423 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2424
2425 Example:
2426 mailers mymailers
2427 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2428 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2429
2430 backend mybackend
2431 mode tcp
2432 balance roundrobin
2433
2434 email-alert mailers mymailers
2435 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2436 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2437
2438 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2439 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2440
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002441timeout mail <time>
2442 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2443 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2444 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2445 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2446
2447 Example:
2448 mailers mymailers
2449 timeout mail 20s
2450 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002451
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024523.7. Programs
2453-------------
2454In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2455master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2456managed the same way as the workers.
2457
2458During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2459sequence as a worker:
2460
2461 - the master is re-executed
2462 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2463 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2464 instance of the program
2465
2466During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2467
2468program <name>
2469 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2470 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2471 the management guide).
2472
2473command <command> [arguments*]
2474 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2475 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2476 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2477 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2478
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002479user <user name>
2480 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2481 See also "group".
2482
2483group <group name>
2484 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2485 See also "user".
2486
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002487option start-on-reload
2488no option start-on-reload
2489 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2490 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2491 program section.
2492
2493
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024943.8. HTTP-errors
2495----------------
2496
2497It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2498imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2499several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2500
2501http-errors <name>
2502 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2503 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2504
2505errorfile <code> <file>
2506 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2507
2508 Arguments :
2509 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2510 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2511 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2512
2513 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2514 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2515 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2516 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2517 before any chroot is performed.
2518
2519 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2520
2521 Example:
2522 http-errors website-1
2523 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2524 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2525 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2526
2527 http-errors website-2
2528 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2529 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2530 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2531
2532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002534----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002537 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538 - frontend <name>
2539 - backend <name>
2540 - listen <name>
2541
2542A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2543its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2544section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002546
2547A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2548connections.
2549
2550A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2551to forward incoming connections.
2552
2553A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2554parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2557'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2558case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2559
2560Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2561logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2562proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2563However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2564name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2565
2566Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2567and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002568bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2570modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2571arbitrary criteria.
2572
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002573In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2574a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002575the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002576
2577 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2578 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2579 between responses and new requests.
2580
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002581 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2582 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2583 client-facing connection remains open.
2584
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002585 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2586 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002587
2588The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2589frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2590following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002591weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002592
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002593 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002594
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002595 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2596 ----+-----+-----+----
2597 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2598 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002599 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2600 ----+-----+-----+----
2601 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026054.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2606--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002608The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2609limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2610they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2611limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002613option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002614and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2615with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2616specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002618
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002619 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2620------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2621acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002622backlog X X X -
2623balance X - X X
2624bind - X X -
2625bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626capture cookie - X X -
2627capture request header - X X -
2628capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002629compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002630cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002631declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002632default-server X - X X
2633default_backend X X X -
2634description - X X X
2635disabled X X X X
2636dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002637email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002638email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002639email-alert mailers X X X X
2640email-alert myhostname X X X X
2641email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002642enabled X X X X
2643errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002644errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002645errorloc X X X X
2646errorloc302 X X X X
2647-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2648errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002649force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002650filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002651fullconn X - X X
2652grace X X X X
2653hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002654http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002656http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002657http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002659http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002660http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002661http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002662id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002663ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002664load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002665log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002666log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002667log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002668log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002669max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002670maxconn X X X -
2671mode X X X X
2672monitor fail - X X -
2673monitor-net X X X -
2674monitor-uri X X X -
2675option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2676option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2677option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2678option allbackups (*) X - X X
2679option checkcache (*) X - X X
2680option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2681option contstats (*) X X X -
2682option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2683option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002684-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2685option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002686option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2687option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002688option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002689option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002690option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002691option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002692option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002693option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2694option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2695option httpchk X - X X
2696option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002697option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002699option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002700option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002701option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002702option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2703option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2704option logasap (*) X X X -
2705option mysql-check X - X X
2706option nolinger (*) X X X X
2707option originalto X X X X
2708option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002709option pgsql-check X - X X
2710option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002711option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002712option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002713option smtpchk X - X X
2714option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2715option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2716option splice-request (*) X X X X
2717option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002718option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002719option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2720option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2721-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002722option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002723option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2724option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2725option tcpka X X X X
2726option tcplog X X X X
2727option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002728external-check command X - X X
2729external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002730persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2731rate-limit sessions X X X -
2732redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002735retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002736server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002737server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002738server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002740stats admin - X X X
2741stats auth X X X X
2742stats enable X X X X
2743stats hide-version X X X X
2744stats http-request - X X X
2745stats realm X X X X
2746stats refresh X X X X
2747stats scope X X X X
2748stats show-desc X X X X
2749stats show-legends X X X X
2750stats show-node X X X X
2751stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002752-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2753stick match - - X X
2754stick on - - X X
2755stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002756stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002757stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002758tcp-check connect - - X X
2759tcp-check expect - - X X
2760tcp-check send - - X X
2761tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002762tcp-request connection - X X -
2763tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002764tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002765tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002766tcp-response content - - X X
2767tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002768timeout check X - X X
2769timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002770timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002771timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002772timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2773timeout http-request X X X X
2774timeout queue X - X X
2775timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002776timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002778timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002779transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002780unique-id-format X X X -
2781unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002782use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002783use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002784use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2786 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027894.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2790---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
2792This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2793
2794
2795acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2796 Declare or complete an access list.
2797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2798 no | yes | yes | yes
2799 Example:
2800 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2801 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2802 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002804 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805
2806
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002807backlog <conns>
2808 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 yes | yes | yes | no
2811 Arguments :
2812 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2813 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002814 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002815
2816 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2817 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2818 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2819 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2820 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2821 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2822 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2823 backlog parameter.
2824
2825 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2826 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2827 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2828
2829 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2830
2831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002833balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2836 yes | no | yes | yes
2837 Arguments :
2838 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2839 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2840 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2841 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2842
2843 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2844 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2845 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2846 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002847 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002848 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002849 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2850 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2851 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2852 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2853 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2854 it, so that you don't worry.
2855
2856 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2857 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2858 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2859 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2860 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2861 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2862 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2863 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002865 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2866 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2867 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2868 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2869 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2870 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2871 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2872 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2873
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002874 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002875 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002876 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2877 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002878 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002879 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2880 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2881 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2882 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2883 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002884 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2885 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2886 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2887 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2888 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2889 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2892 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2893 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2894 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2895 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2896 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2897 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2898 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002899 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002901 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2902 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2903 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002904
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002905 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2906 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2907 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2908 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2909 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2910 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2911 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2912 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2913 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2914 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2915 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2916 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002918 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002919 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2920 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2921 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2922 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2923 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2924 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2925 URIs start with a leading "/".
2926
2927 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2928 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2929 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2930 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2931
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002933 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2934
2935 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002936 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2937 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002938 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2939 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2940 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2941 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002942 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002943 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2944 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002945
2946 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2947 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2948 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2949 server will receive the request.
2950
2951 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2952 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2953 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2954 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2955 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002956 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2957 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2958 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002960 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2961 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2962 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2963 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2964 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002966 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002967 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2968 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2969 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2970
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002971 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2972 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2973 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2974
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002975 random
2976 random(<draws>)
2977 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002978 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2979 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2980 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2981 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002982 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2983 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2984 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2985 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2986 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2987 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2988 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2989 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2990 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2991 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2992 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2993 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2994 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2995 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2996 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2997 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2998 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2999 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3000 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3001 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003002
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003003 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003004 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003005 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3006 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3007 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3008 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3009 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3010 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003011 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003012 used instead.
3013
3014 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3015 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3016 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3017 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3018
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003019 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3020 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3021 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3022
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003023 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003025 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003026 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3027 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003028
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003029 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3030 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3031 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003033 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003034 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003035 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3036 NTLM relies on.
3037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038 Examples :
3039 balance roundrobin
3040 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003041 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003042 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3043 balance hdr(host)
3044 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003045
3046 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3047 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003049 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003050 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3051 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3052 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003053 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003054
3055 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3056 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3057 defaults to 16 kB.
3058
3059 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3060 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3061
3062 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3063 Round Robin.
3064
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003065 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003066 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3067 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3068 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3069
3070 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3071
3072 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003073 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003074 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3075 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3076 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003078 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003079
3080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003081bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3082bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 no | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003087 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3088 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3089 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3090 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003091 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003092 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3093 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3094 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3095 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3096 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3097 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3098 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003099 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3100 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3101 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3102 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3103 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3104 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3105 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003106 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3107 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3108 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003109 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3110 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3111 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3112 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003113 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3114 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3115 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003116
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003117 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3118 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003119 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3120 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3121 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003122 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3123 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3124 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3125 the range.
3126
3127 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3128 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3129 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3130 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3131 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3132 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3133 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003134 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003135 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003136
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003137 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003138 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003139 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3140 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3141 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3142 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3143 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3144 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3145
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003146 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3147 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3148 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3149 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3152 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3153 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3154 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3155 in a frontend.
3156
3157 Example :
3158 listen http_proxy
3159 bind :80,:443
3160 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003161 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003163 listen http_https_proxy
3164 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003165 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003166
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003167 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3168 bind ipv6@:80
3169 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3170 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3171
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003172 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003173 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003174
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003175 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3176 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3177 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3178 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3179 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3180
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003181 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003182 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183
3184
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003185bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003186 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3188 yes | yes | yes | yes
3189 Arguments :
3190 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3191 may be used to override a default value.
3192
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003193 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003194 option may be combined with other numbers.
3195
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003196 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003197 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3198 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3199 missing from all processes.
3200
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003201 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003202 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003203 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3204 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3205 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3206 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3207 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003208 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003209
3210 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3211 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3212 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3213 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3214 and 'even' instances.
3215
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003216 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3217 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3218 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3219 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003220
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003221 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3222 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3223
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003224 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3225 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3226 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3227
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003228 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3229 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3230
3231 Example :
3232 listen app_ip1
3233 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003234 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003235
3236 listen app_ip2
3237 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003238 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003239
3240 listen management
3241 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003242 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003243
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003244 listen management
3245 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3246 bind-process 1-4
3247
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003248 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003249
3250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251capture cookie <name> len <length>
3252 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3254 no | yes | yes | no
3255 Arguments :
3256 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3257 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3258 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3259 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003260 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003261
3262 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3263 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3264 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3265 right if it exceeds <length>.
3266
3267 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3268 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3269 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3270 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3271
3272 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3273 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3274 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3275
3276 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3277 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3278 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003279 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3280 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3281 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003282
3283 Example:
3284 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3285
3286 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003287 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003288
3289
3290capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003291 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3293 no | yes | yes | no
3294 Arguments :
3295 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003296 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3298 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3299 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3300
3301 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3302 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3303 it exceeds <length>.
3304
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003305 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3307 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003308 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3309 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3310 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3311 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003312 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003313 environments to find where the request came from.
3314
3315 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3316 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3317 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3318 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003320 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3321 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3322 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3323 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3324 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003325
3326 Example:
3327 capture request header Host len 15
3328 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003329 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003331 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 about logging.
3333
3334
3335capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003336 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3338 no | yes | yes | no
3339 Arguments :
3340 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003341 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003342 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3343 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3344 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3345
3346 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3347 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3348 it exceeds <length>.
3349
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003350 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3352 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3353 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003354 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3355 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3356 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3357 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003359 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3360 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3361 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3362 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3363 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
3365 Example:
3366 capture response header Content-length len 9
3367 capture response header Location len 15
3368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003369 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370 about logging.
3371
3372
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003373compression algo <algorithm> ...
3374compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003375compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003376 Enable HTTP compression.
3377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3378 yes | yes | yes | yes
3379 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003380 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3381 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3382 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3383
3384 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003385 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3386 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3387 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003388
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003389 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003390 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003391
3392 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3393 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3394 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3395 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3396 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003397 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003398
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003399 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3400 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3401 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3402 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3403 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3404 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3405 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003406 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003407
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003408 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003409 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003410 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3411 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3412 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3413 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3414 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003415
3416 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3417 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3418 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3419 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3420 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003421 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3422 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3423 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3424 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3425 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003426 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3427 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003428
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003429 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003430 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3431 "Accept-Encoding" header
3432 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003433 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003434 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3435 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3436 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3437 "multipart"
3438 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3439 header
3440 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3441 and later
3442 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3443 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003444 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003445
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003446 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003447
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003448 Examples :
3449 compression algo gzip
3450 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003452
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003453cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003454 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3455 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003456 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003457 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3459 yes | no | yes | yes
3460 Arguments :
3461 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3462 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3463 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3464 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3465 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3466 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003467 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3469 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3470
3471 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3472 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3473 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3474 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3475 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3476 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003477 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3478 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003479 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003480 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3481 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482
3483 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003484 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003485
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003486 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003487 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003488 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003489 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003490 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3491 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3492 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3493 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3494 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3495 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3496 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003497
3498 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3499 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3500 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3501 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3502 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3503 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3504 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3505 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3506 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003507 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003508 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3509 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3510 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003512 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3513 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3514 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003515 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3516 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3517 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3518 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003519 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3520 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3521 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522
3523 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3524 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3525 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3526 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3527 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3528 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3529 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3530 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3531 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3532
3533 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3534 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3535 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3536 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3537 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3538 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3539 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3540 persistence cookie in the cache.
3541 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3542
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003543 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3544 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3545 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3546 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3547 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003548 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003549 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3550 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3551 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3552 they logout.
3553
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003554 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3555 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3556 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3557 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3558
3559 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3560 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3561 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3562 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3563 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3564 this attribute.
3565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003566 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003567 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003568 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3569 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3570 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3571 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3572 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3573 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003574
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003575 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3576 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3577 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3578 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3579 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3580 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3581 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3582 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003583 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003584 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3585 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3586 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3587 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3588 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3589 the site.
3590
3591 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3592 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3593 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3594 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3595 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3596 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3597 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3598 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3599 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3600 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3601 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3602 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3603 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003604 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003605 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3606 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3607
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003608 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3609 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3610 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3611 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3612 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3613 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3614
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003615 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3616 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3617 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3618 repeated.
3619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3621 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3622 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3623 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003624
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625 Examples :
3626 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3627 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3628 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003629 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003630
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003631 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003633
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003634declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3635 Declares a capture slot.
3636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3637 no | yes | yes | no
3638 Arguments:
3639 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3640
3641 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3642 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3643 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3644 for use in the response.
3645
3646 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003647 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003648 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3649
3650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003651default-server [param*]
3652 Change default options for a server in a backend
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | no | yes | yes
3655 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003656 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3657 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3658 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3659 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003660
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003661 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003662 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3663
3664 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003665
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667default_backend <backend>
3668 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 yes | yes | yes | no
3671 Arguments :
3672 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3673
3674 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3675 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3676 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3677 will catch all undetermined requests.
3678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679 Example :
3680
3681 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3682 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3683 default_backend dynamic
3684
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003685 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003688description <string>
3689 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 no | yes | yes | yes
3692 Arguments : string
3693
3694 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3695 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3696 it describes.
3697 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3698
3699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700disabled
3701 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3703 yes | yes | yes | yes
3704 Arguments : none
3705
3706 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3707 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3708 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3709 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3710 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3711 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3712 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3713
3714 See also : "enabled"
3715
3716
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003717dispatch <address>:<port>
3718 Set a default server address
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003721 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003722
3723 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3724 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3725 during start-up.
3726
3727 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3728 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3729 possible with normal servers.
3730
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003731 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003732 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3733 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3734 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3735 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3736
3737 See also : "server"
3738
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003739
3740dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3741 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3743 yes | no | yes | yes
3744 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3745
3746 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003747 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003748 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3749 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003750 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003751 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003753enabled
3754 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | yes | yes | yes
3757 Arguments : none
3758
3759 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3760 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3761
3762 See also : "disabled"
3763
3764
3765errorfile <code> <file>
3766 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3768 yes | yes | yes | yes
3769 Arguments :
3770 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003771 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3772 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003773
3774 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003775 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003777 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3778 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779
3780 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3781 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3782 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3783
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003784 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003786 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3787 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3788 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3789 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3790
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003791 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3792 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003793 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003794 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3795 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3796 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3797
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003798 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3799 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3800 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003801 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003802 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3803
3804 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3805
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003806 Example :
3807 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003808 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003809 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3810 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003812
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003813errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3814 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3815 section.
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3817 yes | yes | yes | yes
3818 Arguments :
3819 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3820
3821 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3822 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3823 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3824
3825 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3826 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3827 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3828 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3829 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3830 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3831 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3832
3833 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3834 3.8 about http-errors.
3835
3836 Example :
3837 errorfiles generic
3838 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3839
3840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003841errorloc <code> <url>
3842errorloc302 <code> <url>
3843 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | yes | yes | yes
3846 Arguments :
3847 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003848 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3849 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003850
3851 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3852 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3853 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3854 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003855 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856
3857 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3858 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3859 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3860
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003861 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3862
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003863 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3864 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3865 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3866 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003867 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003868 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3869 request.
3870
3871 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3872
3873
3874errorloc303 <code> <url>
3875 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3877 yes | yes | yes | yes
3878 Arguments :
3879 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003880 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3881 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003882
3883 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3884 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3885 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3886 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003887 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003888
3889 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3890 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3891 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3892
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003893 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3894
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003895 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3896 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3897 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3898 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003899 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003900
3901 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3902
3903
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003904email-alert from <emailaddr>
3905 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003906 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003907 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | yes | yes | yes
3909
3910 Arguments :
3911
3912 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3913
3914 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3915 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3916
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003917 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003918 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3919 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003920
3921
3922email-alert level <level>
3923 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3924 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3926 yes | yes | yes | yes
3927
3928 Arguments :
3929
3930 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3931 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3932 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3933
3934 By default level is alert
3935
3936 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3937 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3938 for the proxy.
3939
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003940 Alerts are sent when :
3941
3942 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3943 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3944 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3945 is notice or lower
3946 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3947 and a health check status update occurs
3948
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003949 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3950 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003951 section 3.6 about mailers.
3952
3953
3954email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3955 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3957 yes | yes | yes | yes
3958
3959 Arguments :
3960
3961 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3962
3963 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3964 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3965
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003966 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3967 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003968
3969
3970email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3971 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3972 mailers.
3973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3974 yes | yes | yes | yes
3975
3976 Arguments :
3977
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003978 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003979
3980 By default the systems hostname is used.
3981
3982 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3983 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3984 for the proxy.
3985
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003986 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3987 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003988
3989
3990email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003991 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003992 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3994 yes | yes | yes | yes
3995
3996 Arguments :
3997
3998 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3999
4000 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4001 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4002
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004003 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004004 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4005
4006
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004007force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4008 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004010 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004011
4012 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4013 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4014 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4015 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4016 marked down for maintenance operations.
4017
4018 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4019 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4020 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4021 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4022 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4023 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4024 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4025 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4026 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4027
4028 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4029 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4030 is used.
4031
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004032 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004033 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004034
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004035
4036filter <name> [param*]
4037 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 no | yes | yes | yes
4040 Arguments :
4041 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4042 referenced in section 9.
4043
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004044 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004045 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004046 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4047 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004048
4049 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4050 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4051
4052 Example:
4053 listen
4054 bind *:80
4055
4056 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4057 filter compression
4058 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4059
4060 compression algo gzip
4061 compression offload
4062
4063 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4064
4065 See also : section 9.
4066
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004067
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004068fullconn <conns>
4069 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 yes | no | yes | yes
4072 Arguments :
4073 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4074 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4075
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004076 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004077 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004078 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004079 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4080 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4081 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4082 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4083 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004084 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004086 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4087 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004088 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4089 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4090 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004092 Example :
4093 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4094 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4095 # connections.
4096 backend dynamic
4097 fullconn 10000
4098 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4099 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4100
4101 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4102
4103
4104grace <time>
4105 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004107 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004108 Arguments :
4109 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4110 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4111 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4112
4113 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4114 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004115 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4117
4118 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4119 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4120 simplify it.
4121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004122
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004123hash-balance-factor <factor>
4124 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | no | no | yes
4127 Arguments :
4128 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4129 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004130 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004131
4132 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4133 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4134 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4135 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4136 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4137 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4138 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4139
4140 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4141 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4142 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4143 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4144 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4145
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004146 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4147 consistent hashing mechanism.
4148
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004149 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4150
4151
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004152hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004153 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4155 yes | no | yes | yes
4156 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004157 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4158 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004159
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004160 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4161 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4162 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4163 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4164 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4165 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4166 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4167 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4168 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4169 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004170
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004171 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4172 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4173 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4174 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4175 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4176 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4177 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4178 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4179 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4180 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4181 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4182 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4183 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004184 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4185 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004186
4187 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4188
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004189 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004190 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4191 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4192 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004193 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4194 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4195 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004196
4197 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4198 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004199 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4200 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4201 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4202 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4203
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004204 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4205 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4206 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4207 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4208 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4209 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4210 parameter.
4211
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004212 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4213 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4214 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4215 used on strings.
4216
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004217 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4218
4219 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4220 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4221 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4222 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4223 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4224 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4225 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4226 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4227 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4228 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4229 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4230 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004231
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004232 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4233 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4234 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004235
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004236 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004237
4238
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004239http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4240 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4241 ones).
4242
4243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 no | yes | yes | yes
4245
4246 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4247 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4248 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4249 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4250 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4251 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4252
4253 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4254 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4255 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4256
4257 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4258 below.
4259
4260 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4261 instance.
4262
4263 Example:
4264 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4265 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4266 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4267
4268http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4269
4270 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4271 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4272 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4273 example, or to pass some internal information.
4274 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4275 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4276 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4277
4278http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4279
4280 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4281 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4282
4283http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4284
4285 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4286
4287http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4289
4290 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4291
4292 Example:
4293 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4294
4295 # applied to:
4296 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4297
4298 # outputs:
4299 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4300
4301 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4302
4303http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4304 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4305
4306 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4307
4308 Example:
4309 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4310
4311 # applied to:
4312 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4313
4314 # outputs:
4315 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4316
4317http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4318
4319 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4320 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4321 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4322
4323http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4324 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4325
4326 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4327 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4328 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4329 fallback.
4330
4331 Example:
4332 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4333 http-response set-status 431
4334 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4335 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4336
4337http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4338
4339 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4340 inline.
4341
4342 Arguments:
4343 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4344 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4345 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4346 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4347 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4348 (request and response)
4349 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4350 processing
4351 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4352 processing
4353 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4354 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4355 and '_'.
4356
4357 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4358 followed by some converters.
4359
4360 Example:
4361 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4362
4363http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4364
4365 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4366 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4367 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4368 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4369 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004370 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004371 processing.
4372
4373 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4374 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4375 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4376 rules evaluation.
4377
4378http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4379
4380 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4381 details about <var-name>.
4382
4383 Example:
4384 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4385
4386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004387http-check disable-on-404
4388 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004390 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391 Arguments : none
4392
4393 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4394 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4395 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4396 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4397 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4398 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4399 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4400 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004401 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4402 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4403 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4404
4405 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4406
4407
4408http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004409 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004411 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004412 Arguments :
4413 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4414 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004415 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004416 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4417 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4418 details on the supported keywords.
4419
4420 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4421 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4422 with the usual backslash ('\').
4423
4424 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4425 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4426 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4427 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4428 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4429
4430 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004431 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004432 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4433 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4434 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4435
4436 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004437 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004438 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4439 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4440 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4441 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4442
4443 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004444 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004445 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4446 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4447 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4448 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4449 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004450 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004451 trace).
4452
4453 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004454 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004455 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4456 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4457 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4458 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4459 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004460 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004461
4462 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4463 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4464 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4465 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4466 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4467 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4468 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4469 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4470
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004471 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4472 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4473 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4474
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004475 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4476 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4477
4478 Examples :
4479 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004480 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004481
4482 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004483 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004484
4485 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004486 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004487
4488 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004489 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004491 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004492
4493
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004494http-check send-state
4495 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 yes | no | yes | yes
4498 Arguments : none
4499
4500 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4501 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4502 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4503 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4504 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4505
4506 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4507 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4508 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4509 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4510 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004511 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4512 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4513 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4514
4515 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4516 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4517 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4518
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004519 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4520 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4521 checked in multiple backends.
4522
4523 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4524 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4525
4526 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4527 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4528 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4529 one fails.
4530
4531 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4532 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4533 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4534
4535 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4536 server's queue.
4537
4538 Example of a header received by the application server :
4539 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4540 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4541
4542 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544
4545http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004546 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4547
4548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4549 no | yes | yes | yes
4550
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004551 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4552 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4553 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4554 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4555 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4558 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562 Example:
4563 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4564 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4565 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004567 http-request allow if nagios
4568 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4569 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4570 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004572 Example:
4573 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4574 acl add path /addacl
4575 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4580 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 Example:
4583 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4584 acl setmap path /setmap
4585 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4590 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4593 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4598 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4599 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4600 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4601 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4602 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4603 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4604 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004608 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4609 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4610 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4611 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4612 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4613 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4614 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4615 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4620 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004621
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4626 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4627 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4628 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4629 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 Example:
4632 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4633 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004634
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004635http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004636
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004637 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004639http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004642 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4643 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4644 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4645 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4646 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4647 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4648 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4649 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4650 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4653 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4654 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004655 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4656
4657 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4658 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4659 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4660 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004664 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4665 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4666 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4667 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4668 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4669 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4678 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4679 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4680 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4681 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4682 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004683
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004684http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4685 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4688 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4689 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004690 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4691 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4692 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4693 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4694 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004695 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004696
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004697http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4698 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4699 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4700 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4701
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004702http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4703
4704 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4705 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4706 pointed by <resolvers>.
4707 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4708 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4709 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4710 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4711 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4712 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4713 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4714 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4715 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4716 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4717 to 0.0.0.0.
4718
4719 Example:
4720 resolvers mydns
4721 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4722 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4723 timeout retry 1s
4724 hold valid 10s
4725 hold nx 3s
4726 hold other 3s
4727 hold obsolete 0s
4728 accepted_payload_size 8192
4729
4730 frontend fe
4731 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4732 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4733 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4734
4735 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4736 # which mean DNS resolution error
4737 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4738
4739 default_backend be
4740
4741 backend b_503
4742 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4743 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4744 # 503 error page to end users
4745
4746 backend be
4747 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4748 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4749 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4750 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4751 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4752
4753 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4754 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4755
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004756http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4757
4758 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4759 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4760 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4761 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004762 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4763 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004764
4765 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004769 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4770 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4771 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4772 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4773 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004775http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004777 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4778 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4779 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4780 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004782http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4783 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004784
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004785 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004786 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4787 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4788 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4789 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4790 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004791
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004792 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4793 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4794 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4795 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4796 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004797
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004798 Example:
4799 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4800
4801 # applied to:
4802 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4803
4804 # outputs:
4805 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4806
4807 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004808
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004809 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4810
4811 # applied to:
4812 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004813
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004814 # outputs:
4815 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004816
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004817http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4818 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4819
4820 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4821 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4822 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4823 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4824
4825 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4826 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4827 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4828
4829 Example:
4830 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4831 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4832
4833 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4834 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4835
4836 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4837 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4838 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4839 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4840
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004841http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4842 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4843
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004844 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4845 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4846 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4847 against.
4848
4849 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4850 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4851 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004852
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004853 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4854 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4855 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4856 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4857 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4858 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4859 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4860 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4861 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004862 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4863 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004864
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004865 Example:
4866 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4867 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004868
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004869 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4870 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004872http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4873 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004874
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004875 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4876 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4877 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4878 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004879
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004880 Example:
4881 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004882
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004883 # applied to:
4884 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004885
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004886 # outputs:
4887 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004888
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004889http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4890 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4891 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004892 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004893 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4894
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004895 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004896 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4897 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4898 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4899 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004900 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004901 are followed to create the response :
4902
4903 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4904 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4905 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4906 ignored.
4907
4908 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4909 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4910 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4911 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4912 ignored.
4913
4914 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4915 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4916 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4917 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4918 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4919
4920 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4921 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4922 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4923 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4924 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4925 if any, is ignored.
4926
4927 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4928 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4929 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4930 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4931 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4932 as a raw content.
4933
4934 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4935 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4936 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4937 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4938 considered as a raw string.
4939
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004940 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4941 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4942 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4943 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4944
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004945 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4946 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4947 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4948
4949 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4950
4951 Example:
4952 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4953 if { path /ping }
4954
4955 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4956 if { path /favicon.ico }
4957
4958 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4959 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4960 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004962http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4963http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004965 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4966 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4967 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004968
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004969http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4970 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004971
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004972 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4973 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4974 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4975 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004977http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004979 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4980 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4981 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4982 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4983 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004985 Arguments:
4986 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4987 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989 Example:
4990 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4991 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004993 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4994 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004996http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004998 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4999 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5000 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005002 Arguments:
5003 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5004 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005006 Example:
5007 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5008 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005010 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5011 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5012 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005016 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5017 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5018 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5019 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5020 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005022 Example:
5023 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5024 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5025 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5026 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5027 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5029 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5030 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5031 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005033http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005035 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5036 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5037 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5038 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5039 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005041http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5042 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005044 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5045 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5046 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5047 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5048 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5049 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5050 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5051 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5052 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005054http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005056 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5057 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5058 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5059 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5060 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5061 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5062 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005064http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005066 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5067 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5068 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005070http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005072 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5073 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5074 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5075 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5076 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5077 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5078 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5079 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005081http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005083 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5084 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5085 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5086 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5087 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5088 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005090 Example :
5091 # prepend the host name before the path
5092 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5097 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5098 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5099 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5100 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005102http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005104 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5105 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5106 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5107 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5108 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5109 values have higher priority.
5110 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5111 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5112 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5113 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5114 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005116http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005118 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5119 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5120 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5121 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5122 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5123 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5124 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005126 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005127
5128 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005129 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5130 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005132http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5133 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5134 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5135 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005136 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5137 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005138
5139 Arguments :
5140 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5141 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005142
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005143 See also "option forwardfor".
5144
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005145 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005146 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5147 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5148
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005149 # After the masking this will track connections
5150 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5151 http-request track-sc0 src
5152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005153 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5154 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5155
5156http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5157
5158 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5159 expression.
5160
5161 Arguments:
5162 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5163 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005164
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005165 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005166 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5167 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5168
5169 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5170 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5171 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5172
5173http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5174
5175 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5176 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5177 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5178 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5179 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5180 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5181 information from the request.
5182
5183 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5184
5185http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5186
5187 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5188 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5189 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5190 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5191 path and the query string.
5192 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5193
5194http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5195
5196 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5197 inline.
5198
5199 Arguments:
5200 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5201 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5202 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5203 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5204 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5205 (request and response)
5206 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5207 processing
5208 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5209 processing
5210 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5211 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5212 and '_'.
5213
5214 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5215 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005216
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005217 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005218 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005220http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5221 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005223 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5224 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5225 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5226 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5227 agent name must be used.
5228
5229 Arguments:
5230 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5231
5232 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5233 configuration.
5234
5235http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5236
5237 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5238 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5239 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5240 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5241 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5242 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5243 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5244 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5245 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5246 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5247 action.
5248 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5249 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5250 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5251 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5252 you fully understand how it works.
5253
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005254http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5255
5256 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5257 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5258 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5259 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5260 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005261 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005262 processing.
5263
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005264 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005265 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5266 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5267 rules evaluation.
5268
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005269http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005271
5272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5273 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5274 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5275 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5276 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5277 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5278 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5279 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5280 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5281 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5282 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005283 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5284 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5285 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5286 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5287 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005288 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5289
5290http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5291http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5292http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5293
5294 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5295 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5296 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5297 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5298 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5299 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5300 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5301 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5302 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5303 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5304 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5305 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5306
5307 Arguments :
5308 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5309 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5310 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5311 select which table entry to update the counters.
5312
5313 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5314 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5315 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5316 that table until the session ends.
5317
5318 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5319 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5320 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5321 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5322 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5323 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5324 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5325 useful information.
5326
5327 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5328 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5329 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5330 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5331 checks that make use of it.
5332
5333http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5334
5335 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005336
5337 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005338 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005339
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005340http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5341
5342 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5343 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5344 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5345 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5346 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5347 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5348
5349 Arguments :
5350 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5351
5352 Example:
5353 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005355http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005357 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5358 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5359 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005360
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005362http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005363 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5364
5365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 no | yes | yes | yes
5367
5368 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5369 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5370 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5371 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5372 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5373 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5374
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005375 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5376 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005377
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005378 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005379
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005380 Example:
5381 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005382
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005383 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005384
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005385 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5386 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005388 Example:
5389 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005391 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005392
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005393 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5394 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005395
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005396 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5397 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005398
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005399http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005400
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005401 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5402 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5403 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5404 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5405 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5406 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5407 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5408 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005410http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005412 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5413 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5414 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5415 example, or to pass some internal information.
5416 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5417 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5418 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005420http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005421
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005422 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5423 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005424
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005425http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005426
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005427 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005429http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005431 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5432 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5433 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5434 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5435 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5436 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5437 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005439 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5440 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5441 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5442 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5443 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005444
5445 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5446 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5447 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5448 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005450http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005452 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5453 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5454 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5455 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5456 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5457 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005459http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005461 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005462
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005463http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005465 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5466 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5467 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5468 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5469 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5470 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005471
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005472http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5473 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005474
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005475 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005476 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5477 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005478 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5479 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5480 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5481 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5482 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005483 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005484
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005485http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005487 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5488 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5489 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5490 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5491 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5492 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005493
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005494http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005496
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005497 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5498 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005499
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005500 Example:
5501 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005502
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005503 # applied to:
5504 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005505
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005506 # outputs:
5507 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005508
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005509 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005510
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005511http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5512 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005513
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005514 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005515 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005516
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005517 Example:
5518 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005519
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005520 # applied to:
5521 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005522
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005523 # outputs:
5524 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005525
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005526http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5527 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5528 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005529 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005530 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5531
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005532 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005533 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5534 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5535 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5536 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005537 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005538 are followed to create the response :
5539
5540 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5541 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5542 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5543 ignored.
5544
5545 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5546 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5547 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5548 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5549 ignored.
5550
5551 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5552 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5553 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5554 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5555 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5556
5557 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5558 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5559 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5560 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5561 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5562 if any, is ignored.
5563
5564 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5565 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5566 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5567 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5568 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5569 as a raw content.
5570
5571 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5572 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5573 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5574 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5575 considered as a raw string.
5576
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005577 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5578 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5579 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5580 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5581
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005582 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5583 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5584 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5585
5586 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5587
5588 Example:
5589 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5590 if { status eq 404 }
5591
5592 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5593 string "This is the end !" \
5594 if { status eq 500 }
5595
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005596http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5597http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005599 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5600 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5601 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005602
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005603http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5604 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005605
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005606 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5607 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5608 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5609 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005610
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005611http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005612
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005613 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5614 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5615 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5616 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5617 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005619 Arguments:
5620 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005622 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5623 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005624
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005625http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005627 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5628 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5629 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005630
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005631http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5632
5633 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5634 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5635 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5636 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5637 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5638
5639http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5640
5641 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5642 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5643 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5644 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5645 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5646 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5647 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5648 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5649 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5650
5651http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5652
5653 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5654 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5655 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5656 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5657 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5658 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5659 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5660
5661http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5662
5663 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5664 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5665 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5666 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5667 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5668 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5669 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5670 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5671
5672http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5673 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5674
5675 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5676 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5677 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5678 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005679
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005680 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005681 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5682 http-response set-status 431
5683 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5684 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005686http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005688 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5689 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5690 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5691 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5692 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5693 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5694 based on some information from the request.
5695
5696 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5697
5698http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5699
5700 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5701 inline.
5702
5703 Arguments:
5704 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5705 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5706 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5707 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5708 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5709 (request and response)
5710 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5711 processing
5712 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5713 processing
5714 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5715 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5716 and '_'.
5717
5718 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5719 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005720
5721 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005722 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005724http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005725
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005726 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5727 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5728 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5729 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5730 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5731 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5732 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5733 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5734 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5735 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5736 action.
5737 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5738 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5739 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5740 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5741 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005742
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005743http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5744
5745 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5746 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5747 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5748 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5749 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005750 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005751 processing.
5752
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005753 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005754 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5755 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5756 rules evaluation.
5757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005758http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5759http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5760http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005762 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5763 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5764 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5765 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5766 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5767 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5768
5769http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5770
5771 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5772 about <var-name>.
5773
5774 Example:
5775 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5776
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005777
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005778http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5779 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5780
5781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5782 yes | no | yes | yes
5783
5784 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005785 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5786 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5787 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005788
5789 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5790
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005791 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5792 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5793 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5794 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5795 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5796 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5797 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5798 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5799 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5800 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005801
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005802 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5803 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5804 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5805 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5806 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5807 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5808 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5809 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005810
5811 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5812 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5813 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5814 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5815 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5816 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5817 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5818 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005819 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005820 downsides of rare connection failures.
5821
5822 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5823 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5824 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5825 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5826 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5827 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005828 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005829 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5830 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5831 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5832 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5833 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5834
5835 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005836 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5837 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5838 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005839
5840 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005841 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005842
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005843 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5844 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005845
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005846 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005847
5848 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5849 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5850 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5851
5852 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5853
5854
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005855http-send-name-header [<header>]
5856 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005859 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005860 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5861
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005862 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5863 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5864 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5865 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5866 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5867 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5868 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5869 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5870 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5871 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5872 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5873 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5874 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5875 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5876 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5877 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005878
5879 See also : "server"
5880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005881id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005882 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 no | yes | yes | yes
5885 Arguments : none
5886
5887 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5888 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5889 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005890
5891
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005892ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5893 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005895 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005896
5897 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5898 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5899 and running).
5900
5901 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5902 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5903 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005904 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005905 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5906
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005907 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5908 "unless" condition is met.
5909
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005910 Example:
5911 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5912 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5913 ignore-persist if url_static
5914
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005915 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5916
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005917load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5918 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | no | yes | yes
5921
5922 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5923 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5924 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005925 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005926 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5927 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5928 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5929 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5930
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005931 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005932 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005933 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005934
5935 Arguments:
5936 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5937 named "server-state-file".
5938
5939 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5940 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5941 name is used as a file name.
5942
5943 none don't load any stat for this backend
5944
5945 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005946 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5947 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5948 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005949 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005950 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005951
5952 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5953 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5954
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005955 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005956
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005957 global
5958 stats socket /tmp/socket
5959 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005960
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005961 defaults
5962 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005963
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005964 backend bk
5965 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5966 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005967
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005968
5969 Then one can run :
5970
5971 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5972
5973 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5974
5975 1
5976 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5977 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5978 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5979
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005980 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005981
5982 global
5983 stats socket /tmp/socket
5984 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5985
5986 defaults
5987 load-server-state-from-file local
5988
5989 backend bk
5990 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5991 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5992
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005993
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005994 Then one can run :
5995
5996 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5997
5998 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5999
6000 1
6001 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6002 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6003 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6004
6005 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6006 "show servers state"
6007
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006008
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006009log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006010log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6011 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006012no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006013 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6015 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006016
6017 Prefix :
6018 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6019 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6020 prefix does not allow arguments.
6021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006022 Arguments :
6023 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6024 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6025 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6026 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6027 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6028 parameter.
6029
6030 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6031 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6032
6033 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6034 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6035 standard syslog port).
6036
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006037 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6038 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6039 standard syslog port).
6040
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006041 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6042 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6043 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006044 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006045
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006046 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6047 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6048 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6049 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6050 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6051 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6052 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6053 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6054 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6055 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6056 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6057 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6058 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6059 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6060 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6061 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006062 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6063 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006064
6065 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6066 and "fd@2", see above.
6067
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006068 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6069 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6070 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6071 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6072 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6073 having the logs instantly available.
6074
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006075 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6076 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006077
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006078 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6079 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6080 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6081 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6082 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6083 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6084 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6085 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6086 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6087 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006088 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006089
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006090 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6091 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6092 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6093 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6094 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6095
6096 <sample_size>
6097 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6098 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6099 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6100 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6101 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6102
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006103 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6104 one of the following :
6105
6106 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6107 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6108
6109 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6110 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6111
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006112 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6113 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6114 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6115 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6116 systemd logger consumes.
6117
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006118 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6119 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6120 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6121 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6122
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006123 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6124
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006125 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6126 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6127 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6128
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006129 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6130 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6131 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6132 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006133
6134 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6135 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6136 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006137 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6138 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6139 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6140 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6141 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006142
6143 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6144
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006145 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6146 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6147 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006148
6149 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6150 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6151 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6152 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6153
6154 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6155 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006156
6157 Example :
6158 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006159 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6160 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6161 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006162 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6163 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006164 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006165
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006166
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006167log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006168 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6170 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006171
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006172 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6173 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6174 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6175 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6176 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006177
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006178 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6179 "option httplog" directives.
6180
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006181log-format-sd <string>
6182 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6183 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6184 yes | yes | yes | no
6185
6186 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6187 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6188 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6189 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6190 which covers the log format string in depth.
6191
6192 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6193 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6194
6195 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6196 log format to "rfc5424".
6197
6198 Example :
6199 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6200
6201
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006202log-tag <string>
6203 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6205 yes | yes | yes | yes
6206
6207 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6208 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6209 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6210 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6211 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6212 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6213 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6214 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6215 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006216
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006217max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6218 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6220 yes | no | yes | yes
6221
6222 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6223 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6224 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6225 servers.
6226
6227 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6228 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6229 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6230 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6231 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006232 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006233 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6234 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6235 picking a different server.
6236
6237 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6238 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6239 even if they have to be queued.
6240
6241 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6242 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6243
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006244max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6245 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6246 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6247 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006249maxconn <conns>
6250 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | yes | yes | no
6253 Arguments :
6254 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6255 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6256 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6257 closes.
6258
6259 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6260 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6261 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6262 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006263 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6264 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6265 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6266 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006267
6268 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6269 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6270 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6271
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006272 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6273 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006274
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006275 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6276
6277
6278mode { tcp|http|health }
6279 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6281 yes | yes | yes | yes
6282 Arguments :
6283 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6284 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6285 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6286 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6287
6288 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6289 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6290 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6291 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6292 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6293
6294 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006295 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6296 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6297 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6298 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6299 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6300 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6301 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006302
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006303 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6304 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6305 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006306
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006307 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006308 defaults http_instances
6309 mode http
6310
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006311 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006313
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006314monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006315 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6317 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006318 Arguments :
6319 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6320 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006321 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006322 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6323 backend and its backup.
6324
6325 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6326 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6327 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6328 servers in a list of backends.
6329
6330 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6331 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6332 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6333 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6334 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6335 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6336 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006337 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6338 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006339
6340 Example:
6341 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006342 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006343 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6344 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6345 monitor-uri /site_alive
6346 monitor fail if site_dead
6347
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006348 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006349
6350
6351monitor-net <source>
6352 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6354 yes | yes | yes | no
6355 Arguments :
6356 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6357 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6358 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6359 followed by a mask.
6360
6361 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6362 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006363 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006364 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6365
6366 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6367 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6368 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6369 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006370 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6371 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6372 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006373
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006374 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6375 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6376 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6377 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6378 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6379 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006380
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006381 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6382 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006383
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006384 Example :
6385 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6386 frontend www
6387 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6388
6389 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6390
6391
6392monitor-uri <uri>
6393 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | yes | yes | no
6396 Arguments :
6397 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6398 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6399
6400 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6401 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6402 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6403 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6404 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6405 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6406 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6407 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6408
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006409 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006410 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6411 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6412 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6413 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6414 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6415 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006416
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006417 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6418 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6419 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6420 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6421
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006422 Example :
6423 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6424 frontend www
6425 mode http
6426 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6427
6428 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006430
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006431option abortonclose
6432no option abortonclose
6433 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6435 yes | no | yes | yes
6436 Arguments : none
6437
6438 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6439 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6440 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6441 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006442 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006443 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6444 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6445 encountered while delivering the response.
6446
6447 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6448 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6449 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6450 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6451 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6452 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006453 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006454 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006455 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006456 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6457 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6458 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6459
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006460 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6461 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006462 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6463 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6464 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6465 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6466 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6467 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006468 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006469
6470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6472
6473 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6474
6475
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006476option accept-invalid-http-request
6477no option accept-invalid-http-request
6478 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | yes | yes | no
6481 Arguments : none
6482
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006483 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006484 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006485 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006486 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6487 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6488 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6489 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6490 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006491 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6492 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6493 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6494 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006495 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006496 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006497 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6498 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6499 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006500
6501 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6502 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6503 been confirmed.
6504
6505 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6506 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006507 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6508 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006509 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6510
6511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6513
6514 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6515 stats socket.
6516
6517
6518option accept-invalid-http-response
6519no option accept-invalid-http-response
6520 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6522 yes | no | yes | yes
6523 Arguments : none
6524
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006525 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006526 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006527 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006528 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6529 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6530 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6531 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6532 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006533 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6534 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6535 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006536
6537 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6538 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6539 been confirmed.
6540
6541 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6542 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6543 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6544 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6545
6546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6548
6549 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6550 stats socket.
6551
6552
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006553option allbackups
6554no option allbackups
6555 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6557 yes | no | yes | yes
6558 Arguments : none
6559
6560 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6561 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6562 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6563 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6564 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6565 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6566 order between the backup servers anymore.
6567
6568 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6569 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6570
6571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6573
6574
6575option checkcache
6576no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006577 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6579 yes | no | yes | yes
6580 Arguments : none
6581
6582 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6583 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006584 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006585 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6586 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006587 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006588
6589 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006590 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006591 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006592 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6593 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006594 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006595 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006596 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6597 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006598 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006599 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6600 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006601 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006602 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6603 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6604 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6605 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6606 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6607 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6608 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6609 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6610 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6611
6612 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006613 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6614 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6615 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6616 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006617
6618 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6619 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006620 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006621 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006622
6623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6625
6626
6627option clitcpka
6628no option clitcpka
6629 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | yes | yes | no
6632 Arguments : none
6633
6634 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6635 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006636 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006637 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6638
6639 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6640 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6641 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6642 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6643
6644 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6645 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6646 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6647 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6648 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6649
6650 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6651
6652 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6653 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6654 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6655
6656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6658
6659 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6660
6661
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006662option contstats
6663 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | yes | yes | no
6666 Arguments : none
6667
6668 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6669 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6670 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6671 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006672 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6673 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6674 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6675 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6676 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006677
6678
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006679option dontlog-normal
6680no option dontlog-normal
6681 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6683 yes | yes | yes | no
6684 Arguments : none
6685
6686 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6687 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6688 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6689 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6690 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6691 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6692 logged.
6693
6694 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6695 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6696 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006698 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006699 logging.
6700
6701
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006702option dontlognull
6703no option dontlognull
6704 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6706 yes | yes | yes | no
6707 Arguments : none
6708
6709 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6710 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6711 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6712 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6713 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6714 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006715 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6716 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6717 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006718
6719 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006720 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006721 would not be logged.
6722
6723 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6724 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6725
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006726 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6727 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006728
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006729
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006730option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006731 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6733 yes | yes | yes | yes
6734 Arguments :
6735 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6736 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006737 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006738 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006739
6740 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6741 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6742 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6743 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6744 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6745 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6746 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006747 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6748 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6749 possible that the client has already brought one.
6750
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006751 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006752 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006753 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006754 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006755 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006756 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006757
6758 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6759 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6760 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6761 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6762 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6763 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6764 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6765
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006766 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6767 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6768 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6769 are under the control of the end-user.
6770
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006771 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006772 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6773 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006774 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6775 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6776 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006777
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006778 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006779 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6780 frontend www
6781 mode http
6782 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6783
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006784 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6785 backend www
6786 mode http
6787 option forwardfor header X-Client
6788
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006789 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006790 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006791
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006792
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006793option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6794no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6795 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6797 yes | yes | yes | no
6798 Arguments : none
6799
6800 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6801 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6802 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6803 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6804 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6805 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6806 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6807
6808 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6809 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6810 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6811 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6812 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6813 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6814 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6815 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6816 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6817 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6818
6819 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6820
6821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6823
6824 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6825 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6826
6827
6828option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6829no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6830 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6832 yes | no | yes | yes
6833 Arguments : none
6834
6835 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6836 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6837 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6838 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6839 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6840 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6841 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6842
6843 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6844 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6845 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6846 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6847 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6848 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6849 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6850 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6851 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6852 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6853
6854 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6855
6856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6858
6859 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6860 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6861
6862
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006863option http-buffer-request
6864no option http-buffer-request
6865 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6867 yes | yes | yes | yes
6868 Arguments : none
6869
6870 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6871 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6872 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6873 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6874 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6875 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006876 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6877 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6878 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6879 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006880
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006881 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006882
6883
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006884option http-ignore-probes
6885no option http-ignore-probes
6886 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6888 yes | yes | yes | no
6889 Arguments : none
6890
6891 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6892 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6893 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6894 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6895 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6896 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6897 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6898 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6899 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006900 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6901 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006902 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6903
6904 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6905 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6906 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6907 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6908 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6909 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6910 are often the only way to detect them.
6911
6912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6914
6915 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6916
6917
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006918option http-keep-alive
6919no option http-keep-alive
6920 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6922 yes | yes | yes | yes
6923 Arguments : none
6924
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006925 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6926 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006927 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6928 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006929 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6930 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6931 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006932
6933 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6934 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006935 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6936 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6937 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6938 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6939 situations where this option may be useful :
6940
6941 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006942 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006943
6944 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6945 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6946
6947 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6948 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6949 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6950 request.
6951
6952 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6953 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006954 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6955 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6956 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006957
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006958 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6959 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6960 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6961 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6962 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6963 not set.
6964
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006965 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6966 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6967 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006968
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006969 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006970 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006971 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006972
6973
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006974option http-no-delay
6975no option http-no-delay
6976 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6978 yes | yes | yes | yes
6979 Arguments : none
6980
6981 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6982 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6983 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6984 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6985 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6986 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6987 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6988 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6989 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6990 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6991 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6992 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6993 affected.
6994
6995 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6996 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6997 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6998 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6999 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7000 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7001 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7002 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7003 latency environments.
7004
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007005 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7006
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007007
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007008option http-pretend-keepalive
7009no option http-pretend-keepalive
7010 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007012 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007013 Arguments : none
7014
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007015 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007016 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7017 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7018 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7019 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7020 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7021 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7022 consider the response complete.
7023
7024 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7025 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7026 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7027 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007028 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007029 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7030
7031 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7032 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7033 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7034 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7035 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7036 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7037 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7038
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007039 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7040 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7041 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7042 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7043 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7044 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007045
7046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7048
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007049 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007050 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007051
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007052
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007053option http-server-close
7054no option http-server-close
7055 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 yes | yes | yes | yes
7058 Arguments : none
7059
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007060 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7061 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7062 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7063 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007064 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7065 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7066 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7067 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7068 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7069 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7070 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7071 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7072 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7073 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7074 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007075
7076 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7077 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7078 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7079 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007080 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7081 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007082
7083 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7084 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007085 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7086 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7087 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007088
7089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7091
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007092 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7093 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007094
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007095option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007096no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007097 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7099 yes | yes | yes | no
7100 Arguments : none
7101
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007102 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007103 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7104 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7105 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7106 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7107 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7108 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7109
7110 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7111 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007112 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7113 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7114 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007115
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007116 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7117 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7118 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7119 front of an existing proxy.
7120
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007121 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7122
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007123 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007124
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007125option httpchk
7126option httpchk <uri>
7127option httpchk <method> <uri>
7128option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7129 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | no | yes | yes
7132 Arguments :
7133 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7134 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7135 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7136 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7137 ones.
7138
7139 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7140 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7141 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7142
7143 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7144 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7145 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
7146 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
7147 after "\r\n" following the version string.
7148
7149 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7150 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7151 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7152 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7153 the lack of any response.
7154
7155 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7156
7157 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7158 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7159 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7160
7161 Examples :
7162 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7163 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7164 backend https_relay
7165 mode tcp
7166 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
7167 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7168
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007169 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7170 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7171 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007172
7173
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007174option httpclose
7175no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007176 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7178 yes | yes | yes | yes
7179 Arguments : none
7180
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007181 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7182 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7183 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7184 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007185 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007186
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007187 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7188 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007189 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007190 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7191 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007192
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007193 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7194 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7195 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007196
7197 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7198 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007199 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7200 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7201 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007202
7203 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7204 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7205
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007206 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007207
7208
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007209option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007210 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007212 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007213 Arguments :
7214 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7215 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7216 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007217 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007218 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007219
7220 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7221 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7222 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7223 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7224 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7225 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7226 ports.
7227
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007228 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7229 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007230
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007231 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007233 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007234
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007235
7236option http_proxy
7237no option http_proxy
7238 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7240 yes | yes | yes | yes
7241 Arguments : none
7242
7243 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7244 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7245 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7246 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7247 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7248
7249 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7250 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007251 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7252 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007253
7254 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7255 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7256
7257 Example :
7258 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7259 backend direct_forward
7260 option httpclose
7261 option http_proxy
7262
7263 See also : "option httpclose"
7264
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007265
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007266option independent-streams
7267no option independent-streams
7268 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | yes | yes | yes
7271 Arguments : none
7272
7273 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7274 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7275 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7276 receive data or not.
7277
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007278 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007279 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7280 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7281 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7282 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7283 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7284 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7285 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7286 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7287 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7288 socket buffers.
7289
7290 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7291 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7292 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7293 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7294 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7295
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007296 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007297
7298
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007299option ldap-check
7300 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 yes | no | yes | yes
7303 Arguments : none
7304
7305 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7306 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7307 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7308 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7309
7310 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7311 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7312
7313 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7314 configure it.
7315
7316 Example :
7317 option ldap-check
7318
7319 See also : "option httpchk"
7320
7321
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007322option external-check
7323 Use external processes for server health checks
7324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7325 yes | no | yes | yes
7326
7327 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7328 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7329 command".
7330
7331 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7332
7333 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7334
7335
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007336option log-health-checks
7337no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007338 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 yes | no | yes | yes
7341 Arguments : none
7342
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007343 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7344 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7345 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007346
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007347 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7348 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7349 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7350 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7351 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007353 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007354 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007355
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007356 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7357 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7358 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007359
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007360
7361option log-separate-errors
7362no option log-separate-errors
7363 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7365 yes | yes | yes | no
7366 Arguments : none
7367
7368 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7369 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7370 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7371 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7372 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7373 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7374 provides very important information.
7375
7376 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7377 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7378 error logs.
7379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007380 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007381 logging.
7382
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007383
7384option logasap
7385no option logasap
7386 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7388 yes | yes | yes | no
7389 Arguments : none
7390
7391 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7392 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7393 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7394 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7395 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7396 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7397 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007398 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007399 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7400 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7401
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007402 Examples :
7403 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7404 mode http
7405 option httplog
7406 option logasap
7407 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7408
7409 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7410 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7411 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7412 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007414 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007415 logging.
7416
7417
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007418option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007419 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7421 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007422 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007423 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7424 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007425 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007426
7427 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7428 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007429 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007430 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7431 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7432 in the MySQL table, like this :
7433
7434 USE mysql;
7435 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7436 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7437
7438 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007439 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007440 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7441 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7442 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7443 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7444 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7445 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7446 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7447
7448 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7449 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007450
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007451 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007452
7453 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7454 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7455 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7456 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007457 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7458 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007459
7460 See also: "option httpchk"
7461
7462
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007463option nolinger
7464no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007465 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007468 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007469
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007470 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007471 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7472 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7473 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7474 connections.
7475
7476 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7477 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7478 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7479 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7480 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7481 this too.
7482
7483 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7484 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7485 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7486
7487 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7488 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7489 for servers.
7490
7491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7493
7494
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007495option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7496 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7498 yes | yes | yes | yes
7499 Arguments :
7500 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7501 matching <network>
7502 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7503 header name.
7504
7505 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7506 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7507 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7508 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7509 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7510 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7511 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7512 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7513 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7514 possible that the client has already brought one.
7515
7516 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7517 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7518 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7519 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7520 header and requires different one.
7521
7522 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7523 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7524 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7525 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7526 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7527 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7528 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7529
7530 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7531 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7532 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7533 both are defined.
7534
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007535 Examples :
7536 # Original Destination address
7537 frontend www
7538 mode http
7539 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7540
7541 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7542 backend www
7543 mode http
7544 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7545
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007546 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007547
7548
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007549option persist
7550no option persist
7551 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7552 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7553 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007554 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007555
7556 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7557 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7558 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7559 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7560 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7561 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7562 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7563 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7564 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7565 redirected to another valid server.
7566
7567 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7568 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7569
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007570 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007571
7572
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007573option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7574 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7576 yes | no | yes | yes
7577 Arguments :
7578 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7579 PostgreSQL server.
7580
7581 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7582 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7583 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7584 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7585
7586 See also: "option httpchk"
7587
7588
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007589option prefer-last-server
7590no option prefer-last-server
7591 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7593 yes | no | yes | yes
7594 Arguments : none
7595
7596 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7597 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7598 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7599 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7600 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7601 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7602 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7603 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7604 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007605 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7606 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007607 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7608 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7609 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007610 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7611 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7612 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007613
7614 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7615 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7616
7617 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7618
7619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007620option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007621option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007622no option redispatch
7623 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7625 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007626 Arguments :
7627 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7628 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7629 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007630 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007631 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007632 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007633 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7634 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7635 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007637
7638 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7639 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7640 be able to access the service anymore.
7641
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007642 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7643 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007644
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007645 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7646 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7647 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7648 following order:
7649
7650 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7651
7652 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7653 list, or
7654
7655 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7656
7657 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7658 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7659
7660 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7661 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7662 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7663 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7664
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007665 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007666 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7667 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007669 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7670 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7671
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007672 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007673
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007674
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007675option redis-check
7676 Use redis health checks for server testing
7677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7678 yes | no | yes | yes
7679 Arguments : none
7680
7681 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7682 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7683 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7684 find the "+PONG" response message.
7685
7686 Example :
7687 option redis-check
7688
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007689 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007690
7691
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007692option smtpchk
7693option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7694 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7696 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007697 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007698 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007699 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007700 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7701
7702 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7703 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7704 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7705
7706 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7707 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7708 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7709 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7710 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7711 dead server.
7712
7713 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7714 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007715 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007716 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7717
7718 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7719 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7720 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7721 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007722 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007723
7724 Example :
7725 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7726
7727 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7728
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007730option socket-stats
7731no option socket-stats
7732
7733 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7735 yes | yes | yes | no
7736
7737 Arguments : none
7738
7739
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007740option splice-auto
7741no option splice-auto
7742 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7744 yes | yes | yes | yes
7745 Arguments : none
7746
7747 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7748 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007749 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007750 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007751 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007752 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7753 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7754 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7755 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7756
7757 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7758 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7759 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7760 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7761 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7762 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7763 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7764 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7765 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7766 keyword.
7767
7768 Example :
7769 option splice-auto
7770
7771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7773
7774 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7775 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7776
7777
7778option splice-request
7779no option splice-request
7780 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7782 yes | yes | yes | yes
7783 Arguments : none
7784
7785 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007786 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007787 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7788 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7789 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7790 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7791
7792 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7793
7794 Example :
7795 option splice-request
7796
7797 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7798 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7799
7800 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7801 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7802
7803
7804option splice-response
7805no option splice-response
7806 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7808 yes | yes | yes | yes
7809 Arguments : none
7810
7811 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007812 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007813 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7814 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7815 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7816 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7817
7818 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7819
7820 Example :
7821 option splice-response
7822
7823 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7824 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7825
7826 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7827 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7828
7829
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007830option spop-check
7831 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7833 no | no | no | yes
7834 Arguments : none
7835
7836 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7837 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7838 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7839 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7840
7841 Example :
7842 option spop-check
7843
7844 See also : "option httpchk"
7845
7846
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007847option srvtcpka
7848no option srvtcpka
7849 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7851 yes | no | yes | yes
7852 Arguments : none
7853
7854 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7855 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007856 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007857 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7858
7859 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7860 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7861 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7862 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7863
7864 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7865 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7866 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7867 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7868 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7869
7870 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7871
7872 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7873 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7874 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7875
7876 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7877 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7878
7879 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7880
7881
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007882option ssl-hello-chk
7883 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7885 yes | no | yes | yes
7886 Arguments : none
7887
7888 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7889 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7890 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7891 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7892 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7893 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7894 hello message.
7895
7896 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7897 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7898 messages, which is appreciable.
7899
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007900 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7901 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7902 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007903
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007904 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7905
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007906
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007907option tcp-check
7908 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7910 yes | no | yes | yes
7911
7912 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7913 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7914
7915 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7916 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7917 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7918
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007919 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007920 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7921 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7922 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7923 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7924 only.
7925
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007926 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007927 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7928 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7929 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7930 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7931
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007932 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007933 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7934 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007935 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007936 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7937 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7938 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7939 the respective protocols.
7940 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007941 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007942
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007943 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7944 script.
7945
7946 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7947 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7948 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7949 The "comment" is of course optional.
7950
7951
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007952 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007953 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007954 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007955 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007956
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007957 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007958 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007959 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007960
7961 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7962 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007963 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007964 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007965 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007966 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007967 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007968 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007969 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7970 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007971 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007972 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7973 tcp-check expect string +OK
7974
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007975 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007976 (send many headers before analyzing)
7977 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007978 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007979 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7980 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7981 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7982 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007983 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007984
7985
7986 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7987
7988
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007989option tcp-smart-accept
7990no option tcp-smart-accept
7991 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7993 yes | yes | yes | no
7994 Arguments : none
7995
7996 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7997 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7998 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7999 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8000 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8001 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8002
8003 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8004 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8005 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8006 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8007
8008 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8009 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8010 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008011 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008012
8013 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8014 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8015 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8016
8017 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8018 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8019 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8020
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008021 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8022
8023
8024option tcp-smart-connect
8025no option tcp-smart-connect
8026 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 yes | no | yes | yes
8029 Arguments : none
8030
8031 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8032 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8033 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8034 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8035 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8036
8037 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8038 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8039 complex.
8040
8041 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8042 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8043 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8044
8045 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8046 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8047
8048 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8049
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008050
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008051option tcpka
8052 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8054 yes | yes | yes | yes
8055 Arguments : none
8056
8057 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8058 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008059 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008060 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8061
8062 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8063 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8064 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8065 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8066
8067 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8068 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8069 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8070 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8071 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8072
8073 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8074
8075 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8076 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8077 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8078 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8079 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8080 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8081 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8082 backends.
8083
8084 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8085
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008086
8087option tcplog
8088 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008090 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008091 Arguments : none
8092
8093 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8094 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8095 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8096 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8097 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8098 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8099 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8100 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8101
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008102 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008104 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008105
8106
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008107option transparent
8108no option transparent
8109 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008111 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008112 Arguments : none
8113
8114 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8115 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8116 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8117 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8118 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8119 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8120 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8121 appropriate server.
8122
8123 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8124 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8125
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008126 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008127 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008128
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008129
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008130external-check command <command>
8131 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8133 yes | no | yes | yes
8134
8135 Arguments :
8136 <command> is the external command to run
8137
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008138 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8139
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008140 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008141
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008142 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8143 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8144 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8145 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8146 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8147 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008148
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008149 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8150
8151 Environment variables :
8152 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8153 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8154
8155 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8156
8157 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8158
8159 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8160 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8161 for a UNIX socket).
8162
8163 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8164
8165 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8166
8167 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8168
8169 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8170
8171 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8172
8173 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8174 socket).
8175
8176 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8177 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8178
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008179 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8180
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008181 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8182 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8183 failed.
8184
8185 Example :
8186 external-check command /bin/true
8187
8188 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8189
8190
8191external-check path <path>
8192 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 yes | no | yes | yes
8195
8196 Arguments :
8197 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8198
8199 The default path is "".
8200
8201 Example :
8202 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8203
8204 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8205 "external-check command"
8206
8207
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008208persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008209persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008210 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8212 yes | no | yes | yes
8213 Arguments :
8214 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008215 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8216 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008217
8218 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8219 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008220 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008221 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8222 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8223 forwarded to this server.
8224
8225 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8226 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8227 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008228 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008229 a single "listen" section.
8230
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008231 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8232 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8233 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8234
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008235 Example :
8236 listen tse-farm
8237 bind :3389
8238 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8239 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8240 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8241 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8242 persist rdp-cookie
8243 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008244 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008245 balance rdp-cookie
8246 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8247 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8248
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008249 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8250 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008251
8252
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008253rate-limit sessions <rate>
8254 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8256 yes | yes | yes | no
8257 Arguments :
8258 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8259 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8260
8261 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8262 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8263 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8264 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8265 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8266 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8267
8268 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8269 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8270 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8271 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8272
8273 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8274 listen smtp
8275 mode tcp
8276 bind :25
8277 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008278 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008279
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008280 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8281 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8282 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008283
8284 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8285
8286
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008287redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8288redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8289redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008290 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8292 no | yes | yes | yes
8293
8294 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008295 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008296
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008297 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008298 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008299 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8300 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8301 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008302
8303 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8304 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8305 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8306 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8307 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008308 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8309 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8310 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8311 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008312
8313 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8314 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8315 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8316 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8317 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8318 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008319 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008320 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008321 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8322 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8323 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008324
8325 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008326 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8327 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8328 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008329 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008330 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8331 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8332 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8333 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008334
8335 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008336 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008337
8338 - "drop-query"
8339 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8340 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8341 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8342 with a location-type redirect.
8343
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008344 - "append-slash"
8345 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8346 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8347 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8348 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8349
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008350 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8351 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8352 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8353 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8354 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8355 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8356 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8357
8358 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8359 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8360 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8361 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8362 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8363 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8364 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008365
8366 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8367 acl clear dst_port 80
8368 acl secure dst_port 8080
8369 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008370 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008371 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008372 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8373
8374 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008375 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8376 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8377 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008378 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008379
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008380 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8381 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8382 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8383
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008384 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008385 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008386
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008387 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008388 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8389 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8390 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008392 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008393
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008394
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008395retries <value>
8396 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8397 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8398 yes | no | yes | yes
8399 Arguments :
8400 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8401 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8402 default value is 3.
8403
8404 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8405 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8406 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8407
8408 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008409 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8410 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008411
8412 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8413 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8414
8415 See also : "option redispatch"
8416
8417
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008418retry-on [list of keywords]
8419 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8420 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8421 yes | no | yes | yes
8422 Arguments :
8423 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8424 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8425 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8426 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8427
8428 none never retry
8429
8430 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8431 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8432
8433 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8434 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8435 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8436 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8437 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8438 processing the request.
8439
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008440 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8441 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8442 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8443 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8444 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8445 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8446 overflow attack for example).
8447
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008448 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8449 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8450 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8451 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8452 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8453 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8454 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8455 amplify denial of service attacks.
8456
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008457 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8458 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8459 considered to be safe to retry.
8460
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008461 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8462 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8463 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8464 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8465
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008466 all-retryable-errors
8467 retry request for any error that are considered
8468 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8469 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8470 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8471
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008472 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8473 not cumulative.
8474
8475 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8476 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8477 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8478 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8479
8480 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8481 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8482 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8483 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8484 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8485 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8486 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8487 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8488 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8489 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8490 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8491 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8492
8493 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8494 should not use this directive.
8495
8496 The default is "conn-failure".
8497
8498 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8499
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008500server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008501 Declare a server in a backend
8502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8503 no | no | yes | yes
8504 Arguments :
8505 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008506 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008507 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008508
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008509 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8510 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8511 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8512 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008513 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8514 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8515 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8516 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8517 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008518 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8519 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8520 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8521 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8522 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8523 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8524 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008525 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008526 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8527 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8528 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8529 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8530 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8531 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008532 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8533 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008534 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8535 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008536
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008537 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008538 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8539 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8540 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8541 adding this value to the client's port.
8542
8543 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8544 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008545 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008546
8547 Examples :
8548 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8549 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008550 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008551 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8552 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8553 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008554
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008555 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8556 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8557 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8558 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8559 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8560
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008561 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8562 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008563
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008564server-state-file-name [<file>]
8565 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8566 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8567 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8568 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8569 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8570 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8571
8572 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8573 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8574
8575 global
8576 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8577
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008578 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008579 load-server-state-from-file
8580
8581 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8582 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008583
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008584server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8585 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8586 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8588 no | no | yes | yes
8589
8590 Arguments:
8591 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8592
8593 <num | range>
8594 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8595 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8596 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8597 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8598
8599 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8600
8601 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8602
8603 <params*>
8604 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8605 keyword.
8606
8607 Examples:
8608 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8609 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8610 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8611
8612 # or
8613 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8614
8615 # would be equivalent to:
8616 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8617 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8618 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8619
8620
8621
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008622source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008623source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008624source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008625 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8627 yes | no | yes | yes
8628 Arguments :
8629 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8630 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008631
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008632 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008633 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8634 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8635 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8636 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8637 supported prefixes are :
8638 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8639 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8640 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008641 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008642 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8643 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008644
8645 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8646 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008647 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8648 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8649 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008650
8651 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8652 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8653 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8654 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8655 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8656 <addr>.
8657
8658 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8659 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8660 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8661 port.
8662
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008663 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8664 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8665 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8666 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008667 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008668 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8669 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8670 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8671 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8672 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8673 HTTP header.
8674
8675 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8676 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008677 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008678 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8679 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8680 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8681 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8682 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8683 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8684 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8685
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008686 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8687 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8688 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8689 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8690 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8691 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8692
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008693 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8694 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8695 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8696 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8697
8698 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8699 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8700 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8701 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8702 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8703 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8704
8705 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8706 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8707 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8708 there are two methods :
8709
8710 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8711 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8712 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8713 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8714 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8715 of the client ranges may be used.
8716
8717 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8718 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8719 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8720 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8721 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8722 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8723 same session.
8724
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008725 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8726 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8727 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008728 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008729
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008730 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8731
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008732 Examples :
8733 backend private
8734 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8735 source 192.168.1.200
8736
8737 backend transparent_ssl1
8738 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8739 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8740
8741 backend transparent_ssl2
8742 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8743 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8744 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8745
8746 backend transparent_ssl3
8747 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8748 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8749 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8750
8751 backend transparent_smtp
8752 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8753 # with Tproxy version 4.
8754 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8755
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008756 backend transparent_http
8757 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8758 # proxy.
8759 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008761 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008762 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8763
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008764
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008765stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8766 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008768 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008769
8770 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8771 matched.
8772
8773 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8774 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8775
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008776 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8777 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008778 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008779
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008780 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8781 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8782 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8783 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008784
8785 Example :
8786 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8787 backend stats_localhost
8788 stats enable
8789 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8790
8791 Example :
8792 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8793 backend stats_auth
8794 stats enable
8795 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8796 stats admin if TRUE
8797
8798 Example :
8799 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8800 userlist stats-auth
8801 group admin users admin
8802 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8803 group readonly users haproxy
8804 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8805
8806 backend stats_auth
8807 stats enable
8808 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8809 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8810 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8811 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8812
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008813 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8814 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8815 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008816
8817
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008818stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8819 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008821 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008822 Arguments :
8823 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8824
8825 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8826
8827 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8828 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8829 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8830 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8831 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8832 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8833
8834 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8835 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8836 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008837 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008838
8839 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8840 report using "stats scope".
8841
8842 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8843 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8844 unobvious parameters.
8845
8846 Example :
8847 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8848 backend public_www
8849 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8850 stats enable
8851 stats hide-version
8852 stats scope .
8853 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008854 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008855 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8856 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8857
8858 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8859 backend private_monitoring
8860 stats enable
8861 stats uri /admin?stats
8862 stats refresh 5s
8863
8864 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8865
8866
8867stats enable
8868 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008870 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008871 Arguments : none
8872
8873 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8874 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8875 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8876 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8877 - stats auth : no authentication
8878 - stats scope : no restriction
8879
8880 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8881 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8882 unobvious parameters.
8883
8884 Example :
8885 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8886 backend public_www
8887 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8888 stats enable
8889 stats hide-version
8890 stats scope .
8891 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008892 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008893 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8894 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8895
8896 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8897 backend private_monitoring
8898 stats enable
8899 stats uri /admin?stats
8900 stats refresh 5s
8901
8902 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8903
8904
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008905stats hide-version
8906 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008908 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008909 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008910
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008911 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8912 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8913 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8914 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8915 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8916 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008918 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8919 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8920 unobvious parameters.
8921
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008922 Example :
8923 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8924 backend public_www
8925 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008926 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008927 stats hide-version
8928 stats scope .
8929 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008930 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008931 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8932 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008933
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008934 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8935 backend private_monitoring
8936 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008937 stats uri /admin?stats
8938 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008939
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008941
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008942
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008943stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8944 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8945 Access control for statistics
8946
8947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8948 no | no | yes | yes
8949
8950 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8951 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8952 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8953 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8954 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8955 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8956
8957 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8958 instance.
8959
8960 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8961 about ACL usage.
8962
8963
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008964stats realm <realm>
8965 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008967 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008968 Arguments :
8969 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8970 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8971 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8972
8973 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8974 using a backslash ('\').
8975
8976 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8977 only related to authentication.
8978
8979 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8980 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8981 unobvious parameters.
8982
8983 Example :
8984 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8985 backend public_www
8986 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8987 stats enable
8988 stats hide-version
8989 stats scope .
8990 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008991 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008992 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8993 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8994
8995 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8996 backend private_monitoring
8997 stats enable
8998 stats uri /admin?stats
8999 stats refresh 5s
9000
9001 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9002
9003
9004stats refresh <delay>
9005 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009007 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009008 Arguments :
9009 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9010 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9011 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9012 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9013 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9014 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9015
9016 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9017 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9018 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9019 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9020
9021 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9022 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9023 unobvious parameters.
9024
9025 Example :
9026 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9027 backend public_www
9028 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9029 stats enable
9030 stats hide-version
9031 stats scope .
9032 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009033 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009034 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9035 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9036
9037 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9038 backend private_monitoring
9039 stats enable
9040 stats uri /admin?stats
9041 stats refresh 5s
9042
9043 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9044
9045
9046stats scope { <name> | "." }
9047 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009049 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009050 Arguments :
9051 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9052 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9053 section in which the statement appears.
9054
9055 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9056 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9057 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9058 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9059 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9060 exists.
9061
9062 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9063 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9064 unobvious parameters.
9065
9066 Example :
9067 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9068 backend public_www
9069 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9070 stats enable
9071 stats hide-version
9072 stats scope .
9073 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009074 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009075 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9076 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9077
9078 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9079 backend private_monitoring
9080 stats enable
9081 stats uri /admin?stats
9082 stats refresh 5s
9083
9084 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9085
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009086
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009087stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009088 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009090 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009091
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009092 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009093 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9094
9095 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9096 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9097
9098 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9099 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009100 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009101
9102 Example :
9103 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9104 backend private_monitoring
9105 stats enable
9106 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9107 stats uri /admin?stats
9108 stats refresh 5s
9109
9110 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9111 global section.
9112
9113
9114stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009115 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9117 yes | yes | yes | yes
9118 Arguments : none
9119
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009120 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009121 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9122 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9123 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9124 - IP (socket, server)
9125 - cookie (backend, server)
9126
9127 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9128 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009129 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009130
9131 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9132
9133
9134stats show-node [ <name> ]
9135 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009137 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009138 Arguments:
9139 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9140 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9141
9142 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9143 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009144 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009145
9146 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9147 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9148 unobvious parameters.
9149
9150 Example:
9151 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9152 backend private_monitoring
9153 stats enable
9154 stats show-node Europe-1
9155 stats uri /admin?stats
9156 stats refresh 5s
9157
9158 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9159 section.
9160
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009161
9162stats uri <prefix>
9163 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009165 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009166 Arguments :
9167 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9168 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9169 query string.
9170
9171 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9172 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9173 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9174 possible to reach it in the application.
9175
9176 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009177 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009178 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9179 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9180 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9181 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9182
9183 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9184 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9185 an address or a port to statistics only.
9186
9187 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9188 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9189 unobvious parameters.
9190
9191 Example :
9192 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9193 backend public_www
9194 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9195 stats enable
9196 stats hide-version
9197 stats scope .
9198 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009199 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009200 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9201 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9202
9203 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9204 backend private_monitoring
9205 stats enable
9206 stats uri /admin?stats
9207 stats refresh 5s
9208
9209 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9210
9211
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009212stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9213 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009215 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009216
9217 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009218 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009219 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009220 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009221 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9222
9223 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9224 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9225 the "stick-table" statement.
9226
9227 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9228 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9229 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9230 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9231 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9232
9233 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9234 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9235 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9236 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9237 transformation rules.
9238
9239 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9240 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9241 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9242 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9243 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9244 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9245 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9246
9247 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9248 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9249 ACL based conditions.
9250
9251 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9252 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9253 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9254 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9255
9256 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9257 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9258 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9259 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9260
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009261 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9262 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009263 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009264
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009265 Example :
9266 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9267 # last 30 minutes
9268 backend pop
9269 mode tcp
9270 balance roundrobin
9271 stick store-request src
9272 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9273 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9274 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9275
9276 backend smtp
9277 mode tcp
9278 balance roundrobin
9279 stick match src table pop
9280 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9281 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9282
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009283 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009284 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009285
9286
9287stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9288 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9290 no | no | yes | yes
9291
9292 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9293 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9294 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9295 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9296
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009297 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9298 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009299 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009300
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009301 Examples :
9302 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009303 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009304
9305 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9306 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9307 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9308
9309
9310 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9311 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9312 backend http
9313 mode http
9314 balance roundrobin
9315 stick on src table https
9316 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9317 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9318 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9319
9320 backend https
9321 mode tcp
9322 balance roundrobin
9323 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9324 stick on src
9325 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9326 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9327
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009328 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009329
9330
9331stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9332 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9334 no | no | yes | yes
9335
9336 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009337 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009338 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009339 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009340 server is selected.
9341
9342 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9343 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9344 the "stick-table" statement.
9345
9346 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9347 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9348 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9349 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9350 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9351 address.
9352
9353 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9354 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9355 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9356 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9357 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9358 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9359 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9360 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9361 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9362 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9363
9364 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9365 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9366 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9367 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9368 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9369 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9370 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9371
9372 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9373 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9374 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9375 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9376
9377 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9378 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9379 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9380 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9381 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9382 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009383 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9384 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9385 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9386 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9387 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9388 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009389
9390 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9391 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9392 the request.
9393
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009394 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9395 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009396 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009397
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009398 Example :
9399 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9400 # last 30 minutes
9401 backend pop
9402 mode tcp
9403 balance roundrobin
9404 stick store-request src
9405 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9406 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9407 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9408
9409 backend smtp
9410 mode tcp
9411 balance roundrobin
9412 stick match src table pop
9413 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9414 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9415
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009416 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009417 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009418
9419
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009420stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009421 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9422 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009423 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009425 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009426
9427 Arguments :
9428 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9429 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9430 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9431 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9432
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009433 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9434 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9435 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9436 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9437
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009438 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9439 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9440 instance.
9441
9442 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9443 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9444 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9445 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9446 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9447 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009448 to 32 characters.
9449
9450 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9451 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9452 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009453 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009454 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9455 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009456
9457 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009458 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9459 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009460 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9461 increase.
9462
9463 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009464 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9465 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9466 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009467
9468 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9469 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9470 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9471 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009472 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009473 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9474 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9475 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9476 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9477 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9478 parameter (see below).
9479
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009480 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9481 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9482 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9483 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9484 soft restart.
9485
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009486 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9487 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009488
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009489 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9490 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9491 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9492 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009493 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009494 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009495 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9496 if not expiration delay is specified.
9497
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009498 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9499 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9500 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9501 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009502 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9503 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9504 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9505 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9506 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9507 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9508 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9509 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9510 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9511 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9512 types and their arguments.
9513
9514 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9515 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9516 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9517 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9518
9519 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9520 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9521 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009522 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009523
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009524 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9525 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9526 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009527 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009528 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009529 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009530
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009531 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9532 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9533 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9534 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9535
9536 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9537 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9538 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9539 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9540 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9541 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9542
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009543 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9544 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9545 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9546 they were received.
9547
9548 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9549 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9550 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9551 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9552 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9553
9554 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9555 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9556 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9557 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9558 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9559
9560 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9561 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9562 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9563
9564 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9565 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9566 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9567 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9568 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9569
9570 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9571 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9572 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9573 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9574 the client side.
9575
9576 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9577 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9578 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9579 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9580 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9581 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9582 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9583
9584 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9585 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9586 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9587 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9588 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9589 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009590 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009591
9592 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9593 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9594 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9595 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9596 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9597 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9598
9599 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009600 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009601 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9602 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9603
9604 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9605 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9606 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9607 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9608 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9609 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9610 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9611 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9612 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9613 recommended for better fairness.
9614
9615 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009616 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009617 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9618 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9619
9620 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9621 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9622 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9623 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9624 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9625 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9626 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9627 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9628 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9629 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009630
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009631 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9632 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009633 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9634 reference it.
9635
9636 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9637 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009638 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9639 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9640 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009641
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009642 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9643 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9644 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9645 something that can be ignored.
9646
9647 Example:
9648 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9649 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9650 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9651 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9652
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009653 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009654 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009655
9656
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009657stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009658 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9660 no | no | yes | yes
9661
9662 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009663 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009664 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009665 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009666 server is selected.
9667
9668 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9669 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9670 the "stick-table" statement.
9671
9672 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9673 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9674 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9675 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9676
9677 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9678 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9679 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9680 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9681 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9682 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009683 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009684 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9685 rules.
9686
9687 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9688 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9689 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9690 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9691 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9692 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9693 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9694
9695 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9696 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9697 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9698 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9699
9700 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9701 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9702 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9703 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9704 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9705 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009706 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9707 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9708 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9709 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9710 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9711 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9712 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9713 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9714 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009715
9716 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9717
9718 Example :
9719 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9720 backend https
9721 mode tcp
9722 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009723 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009724 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009725
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009726 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9727 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9728
9729 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9730 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9731 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9732
9733 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9734 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009735
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009736 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9737 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9738 # at offset 44.
9739
9740 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9741 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9742
9743 # Learn on response if server hello.
9744 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009745
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009746 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9747 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9748
9749 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9750 extraction.
9751
9752
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009753tcp-check connect [params*]
9754 Opens a new connection
9755 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9756 no | no | yes | yes
9757
9758 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9759 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9760 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9761
9762 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9763 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9764 of the sequence.
9765
9766 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9767 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9768 do.
9769
9770 Parameters :
9771 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9772 use the TCP connection.
9773
9774 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9775 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9776 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9777
9778 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9779
9780 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9781
9782 Examples:
9783 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9784 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9785 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9786 option tcp-check
9787 tcp-check connect
9788 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9789 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9790 tcp-check send \r\n
9791 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9792 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9793 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9794 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9795 tcp-check send \r\n
9796 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9797 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9798
9799 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9800 option tcp-check
9801 tcp-check connect port 110
9802 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9803 tcp-check connect port 143
9804 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9805 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9806
9807 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9808
9809
9810tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009811 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9813 no | no | yes | yes
9814
9815 Arguments :
9816 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9817 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9818 binary.
9819 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9820 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9821 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9822
9823 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9824 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9825 with the usual backslash ('\').
9826 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009827 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009828 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9829 used upper or lower case.
9830
9831
9832 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9833
9834 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9835 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9836 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9837 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9838 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9839 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9840 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9841 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9842
9843 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9844 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9845 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9846 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9847 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9848 expression.
9849
9850 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9851 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9852 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9853 this exact hexadecimal string.
9854 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9855
9856 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9857 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9858 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9859 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9860 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9861 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9862 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9863 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9864 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9865 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9866 the null character.
9867
9868 Examples :
9869 # perform a POP check
9870 option tcp-check
9871 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9872
9873 # perform an IMAP check
9874 option tcp-check
9875 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9876
9877 # look for the redis master server
9878 option tcp-check
9879 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009880 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009881 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9882 tcp-check expect string role:master
9883 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9884 tcp-check expect string +OK
9885
9886
9887 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9888 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9889
9890
9891tcp-check send <data>
9892 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9894 no | no | yes | yes
9895
9896 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9897 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9898
9899 Examples :
9900 # look for the redis master server
9901 option tcp-check
9902 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9903 tcp-check expect string role:master
9904
9905 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9906 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9907
9908
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009909tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9910 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009911 tcp health check
9912 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9913 no | no | yes | yes
9914
9915 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9916 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009917 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009918 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9919 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9920 hexadecimal string.
9921 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9922
9923 Examples :
9924 # redis check in binary
9925 option tcp-check
9926 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9927 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9928
9929
9930 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9931 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9932
9933
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009934tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9935 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9937 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009938 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009939 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9940 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009942 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009943
9944 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9945 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009946 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9947 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9948 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9949 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9950 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9951 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009953 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9954 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9955 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9956 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009957
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009958 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009959 - accept :
9960 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9961 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9962 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009964 - reject :
9965 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9966 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9967 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9968 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9969 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9970 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9971 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9972 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9973 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9974 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9975 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009976 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009977
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009978 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9979 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9980 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9981 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9982 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9983 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9984 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9985 hosts.
9986
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009987 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9988 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9989 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9990 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9991 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9992 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9993 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9994 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9995
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009996 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9997 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9998 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9999 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10000 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10001 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10002 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10003 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10004 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010005 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10006 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010007
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010008 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010009 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010010 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10011 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10012 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010013 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010014 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10015 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10016 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10017 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10018 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10019 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10020 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10021 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010022
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010023 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010024 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010025 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010026 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010027 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10028 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10029 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010031 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10032 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10033 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10034 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010036 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10037 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10038 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10039 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10040 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010041 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10042 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10043 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10044 layer7 information is extracted.
10045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010046 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10047 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10048 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10049 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10050 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010051
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010052 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10053 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10054 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10055 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10056
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010057 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10058 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10059 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10060 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10061
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010062 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10063 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10064 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10065 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10066 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010067
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010068 - set-src <expr> :
10069 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10070 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10071 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010072 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010074 Arguments:
10075 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10076 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010077
10078 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010079 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10080
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010081 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10082 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010083
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010084 - set-src-port <expr> :
10085 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10086 expression.
10087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010088 Arguments:
10089 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10090 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010091
10092 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010093 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10094
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010095 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10096 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10097 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010098
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010099 - set-dst <expr> :
10100 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10101 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10102 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10103 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10104 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10105
10106 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10107 followed by some converters.
10108
10109 Example:
10110
10111 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10112 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10113
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010114 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10115 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10116
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010117 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10118 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10119 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10120 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10121
10122
10123 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10124 followed by some converters.
10125
10126 Example:
10127
10128 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10129
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010130 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10131 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10132 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10133
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010134 - "silent-drop" :
10135 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010136 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010137 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10138 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10139 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10140 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10141 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010142 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10143 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010144 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10145 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010146 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010147 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10148 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10149 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10150 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10151
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010152 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10153 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10154 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010156 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10157 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10158 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010159
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010160 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010161 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010162 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010164 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10165 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10166 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010167
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010168 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010169 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10170 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010171
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010172 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10173
10174 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10175
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010176 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10177
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010178 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010179
10180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010181tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10182 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010184 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010185 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010186 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10187 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010188
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010189 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010190
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010191 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010192 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10193 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10194 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10195 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010196
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010197 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10198 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10199 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10200 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010201 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10202 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10203 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10204 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10205 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10206 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010207 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010208 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010209
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010210 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10211 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10212 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10213 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010214
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010215 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010216 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010217 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010218 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10219 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010220 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010221 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010222 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010223 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010224 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010225 - set-dst <expr>
10226 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010227 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010228 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010229 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010230 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010231 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010232
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010233 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10234 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010235 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10236 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010237
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010238 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10239 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10240 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10241 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10242 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10243 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010245 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010246 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10247 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010249 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010250 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10251 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10252 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10253 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010254 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10255 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10256 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010257
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010258 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010259 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10260 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10261 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010262
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010263 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10264 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10265
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010266 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010267 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10268 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010269
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010270 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10271 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010272 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010273 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10274 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010275 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010276 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010277 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010278 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10279 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010280 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010281 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10282 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010283
10284 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10285 followed by some converters.
10286
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010287 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10288 <var-name>.
10289
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010290 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10291 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10292 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10293 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10294 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10295
10296 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10297 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10298 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10299 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10300 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10301 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10302 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10303 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10304 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10305 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10306 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10307
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010308 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10309 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10310 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10311 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10312 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10313
10314 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10315
10316 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10317
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010318 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10319 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10320 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10321 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10322 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10323 evaluated.
10324
10325 Example:
10326 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10327
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010328 Example:
10329
10330 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010331 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010332
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010333 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010334 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10335 # and reject everything else.
10336 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10337 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010338 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010339 tcp-request content reject
10340
10341 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010342 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10343 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10344 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010345 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010346
10347 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10348 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10349 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010350 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010351 tcp-request content reject
10352
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010353 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010354 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010355 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010356 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010357 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10358 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010359
10360 Example:
10361 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10362 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010363 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010364
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010365 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010366 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010367
10368 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010369 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010370 # protecting all our sites
10371 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010372 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10373 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010374 ...
10375 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10376
10377 backend http_dynamic
10378 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010379 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010380 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010381 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010382 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010383 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010384 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010386 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010387
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010388 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10389 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010390
10391
10392tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10393 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010395 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010396 Arguments :
10397 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10398 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10399 as explained at the top of this document.
10400
10401 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10402 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10403 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10404 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10405 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10406
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010407 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10408 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10409 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10410 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10411
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010412 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10413 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010414 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010415 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010416 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10417 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10418 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10419 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010420
10421 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10422 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10423 it pass through unaffected.
10424
10425 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10426 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10427 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010428 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010429 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10430 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010431 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10432 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10433 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010434
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010435 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010436 "timeout client".
10437
10438
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010439tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10440 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10442 no | no | yes | yes
10443 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010444 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10445 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010446
10447 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10448
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010449 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010450 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10451 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010452 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10453 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010454
10455 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10456
10457 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10458 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10459 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10460 inserted.
10461
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010462 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010463 - accept :
10464 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10465 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10466 the rules evaluation.
10467
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010468 - close :
10469 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10470 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10471 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10472 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10473 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10474 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010475 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010476 protocols.
10477
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010478 - reject :
10479 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10480 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010481 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010482
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010483 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10484 Sets a variable.
10485
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010486 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10487 Unsets a variable.
10488
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010489 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10490 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10491 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10492 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10493
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010494 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10495 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10496 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10497 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10498
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010499 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10500 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10501 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10502 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10503 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010504
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010505 - "silent-drop" :
10506 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010507 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010508 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10509 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10510 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10511 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10512 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010513 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10514 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010515 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10516 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010517 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010518 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10519 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10520 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10521 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10522
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010523 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10524 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10525
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010526 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10527 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10528 for changing the default action to a reject.
10529
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010530 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10531 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10532 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10533 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010534 period.
10535
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010536 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10537 declared inline.
10538
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010539 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10540 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010541 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010542 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10543 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010544 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010545 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010546 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010547 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10548 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010549 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010550 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10551 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010552
10553 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10554 followed by some converters.
10555
10556 Example:
10557
10558 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10559
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010560 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10561 <var-name>.
10562
10563 Example:
10564
10565 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10566
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010567 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10568 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10569 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10570 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10571 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10572
10573 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10574
10575 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10576
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010577 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10578
10579 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10580
10581
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010582tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10583 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10585 no | yes | yes | no
10586 Arguments :
10587 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10588 below.
10589
10590 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10591
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010592 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010593 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10594 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10595 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10596 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10597 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10598 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10599 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010600 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010601 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10602 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10603 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10604 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10605 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10606 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10607 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10608 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10609 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10610 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10611 instead.
10612
10613 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10614 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10615 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10616 rules which may be inserted.
10617
10618 Several types of actions are supported :
10619 - accept : the request is accepted
10620 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10621 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10622 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010623 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010624 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010625 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010626 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010627 - silent-drop
10628
10629 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10630 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10631 sections for a complete description.
10632
10633 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10634 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10635 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10636
10637 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10638 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10639 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10640 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10641 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10642
10643 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10644 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10645
10646 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10647 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10648 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10649
10650 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10651 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10652 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10653
10654 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10655 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10656 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10657
10658 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10659 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10660 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10661
10662 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10663
10664 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10665
10666
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010667tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10668 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10670 no | no | yes | yes
10671 Arguments :
10672 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10674 as explained at the top of this document.
10675
10676 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10677
10678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010679timeout check <timeout>
10680 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10681 established.
10682
10683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10684 yes | no | yes | yes
10685 Arguments:
10686 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10687 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10688 as explained at the top of this document.
10689
10690 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10691 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010692 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010693 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010694 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10695 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10696 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010697
10698 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10699 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10700
10701 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10702 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010703 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010704
10705 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10706 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10707 forget about it.
10708
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010709 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10710 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010711
10712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010713timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010714 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10716 yes | yes | yes | no
10717 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010718 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010719 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10720 as explained at the top of this document.
10721
10722 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10723 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10724 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010725 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10726 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10727 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10728 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010729 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10730 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10731 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010732 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010733 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010734 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10735 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010736 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10737 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010738
10739 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10740 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10741 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10742 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010743 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010744 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10745
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010746 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010747
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010748 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010750
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010751timeout client-fin <timeout>
10752 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10754 yes | yes | yes | no
10755 Arguments :
10756 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10757 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10758 as explained at the top of this document.
10759
10760 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10761 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10762 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10763 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10764 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10765 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10766 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010767 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10768 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10769 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010770
10771 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10772 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10773 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10774
10775 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10776
10777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010778timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010779 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10781 yes | no | yes | yes
10782 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010783 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010784 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10785 as explained at the top of this document.
10786
10787 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010788 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010789 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010790 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010791 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10792 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010793
10794 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10795 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10796 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10797 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010798 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010799 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10800
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010801 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010803
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010804timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10805 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10807 yes | yes | yes | yes
10808 Arguments :
10809 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10810 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10811 as explained at the top of this document.
10812
10813 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10814 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10815 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10816 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10817 once the request has started to present itself.
10818
10819 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10820 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10821 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10822 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10823 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10824
10825 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10826 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10827 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10828 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10829
10830 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10831 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010832 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010833 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10834 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010835 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010836
10837 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10838 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10839 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10840 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10841
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010842 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10843 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010844 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10845
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010846 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10847
10848
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010849timeout http-request <timeout>
10850 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010852 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010853 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010854 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010855 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10856 as explained at the top of this document.
10857
10858 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10859 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10860 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10861 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10862 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10863 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10864 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010865 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10866 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10867 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10868 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010869 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010870 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10871 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010872
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010873 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10874 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10875 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10876 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10877 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010878 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010879
10880 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10881 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010882 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010883 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10884 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10885
10886 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010887 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10888 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10889 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010890
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010891 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010892 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010893
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010894
10895timeout queue <timeout>
10896 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10898 yes | no | yes | yes
10899 Arguments :
10900 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10901 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10902 as explained at the top of this document.
10903
10904 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10905 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10906 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10907 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10908 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10909
10910 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10911 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10912 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10913 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10914
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010915 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010916
10917
10918timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010919 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10921 yes | no | yes | yes
10922 Arguments :
10923 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10924 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10925 as explained at the top of this document.
10926
10927 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10928 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10929 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10930 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10931 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10932 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10933 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10934
10935 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10936 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10937 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10938 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10939 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010940 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010941 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010942 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10943 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010944 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10945 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010946
10947 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10948 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10949 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10950 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010951 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010952 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10953
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010954 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010955
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010956
10957timeout server-fin <timeout>
10958 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10960 yes | no | yes | yes
10961 Arguments :
10962 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10963 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10964 as explained at the top of this document.
10965
10966 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10967 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10968 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10969 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10970 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10971 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10972 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10973 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10974 situations, it should not be needed.
10975
10976 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10977 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10978 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10979
10980 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10981
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010982
10983timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010984 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10986 yes | yes | yes | yes
10987 Arguments :
10988 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10989 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10990 as explained at the top of this document.
10991
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010992 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10993 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10994 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010995
10996 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10997 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10998 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10999 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011000 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011001
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011002 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011003
11004
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011005timeout tunnel <timeout>
11006 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11008 yes | no | yes | yes
11009 Arguments :
11010 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11011 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11012 as explained at the top of this document.
11013
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011014 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011015 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11016 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11017 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011018 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11019 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011020 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11021 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11022 specified.
11023
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011024 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11025 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11026 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11027 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11028 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11029 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11030 state.
11031
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011032 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11033 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11034 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11035 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011036 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011037
11038 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11039 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11040 forget about it.
11041
11042 Example :
11043 defaults http
11044 option http-server-close
11045 timeout connect 5s
11046 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011047 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011048 timeout server 30s
11049 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11050
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011051 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011052
11053
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011054transparent (deprecated)
11055 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011057 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011058 Arguments : none
11059
11060 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11061 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11062 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11063 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11064 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11065 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11066 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11067 appropriate server.
11068
11069 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11070
11071 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11072 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11073
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011074 See also: "option transparent"
11075
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011076unique-id-format <string>
11077 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11079 yes | yes | yes | no
11080 Arguments :
11081 <string> is a log-format string.
11082
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011083 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11084 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11085 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11086 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011087
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011088 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11089 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11090 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11091 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11092 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11093 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11094 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11095 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011096
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011097 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11098 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011099
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011100 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011101
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011102 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011103
11104 will generate:
11105
11106 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11107
11108 See also: "unique-id-header"
11109
11110unique-id-header <name>
11111 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11113 yes | yes | yes | no
11114 Arguments :
11115 <name> is the name of the header.
11116
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011117 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11118 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011119
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011120 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011121
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011122 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011123 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11124
11125 will generate:
11126
11127 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11128
11129 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011130
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011131use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011132 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11134 no | yes | yes | no
11135 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011136 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11137 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011138
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011139 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11140 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011141
11142 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11143 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11144 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011145 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011146 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011147 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11148 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011149
11150 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11151 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11152 assign the backend.
11153
11154 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11155 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11156 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11157 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11158 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11159 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11160
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011161 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011162 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011163 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11164 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11165 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11166
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011167 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11168 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11169 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11170 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11171 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11172 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11173 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11174 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11175 cannot be forced from the request.
11176
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011177 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011178 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11179 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11180
11181 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11182 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011183
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011184use-fcgi-app <name>
11185 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11187 no | no | yes | yes
11188 Arguments :
11189 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11190
11191 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011192
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011193use-server <server> if <condition>
11194use-server <server> unless <condition>
11195 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11197 no | no | yes | yes
11198 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011199 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11200 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011201
11202 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11203
11204 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11205 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11206 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11207
11208 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11209 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11210 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11211 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11212 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11213 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11214 matches will assign the server.
11215
11216 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11217 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11218 with the next rules until one matches.
11219
11220 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11221 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11222 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11223 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11224
11225 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11226 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11227 stripped.
11228
11229 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11230 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11231 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11232 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11233
11234 Example :
11235 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11236 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11237 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11238 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11239 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11240 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011241 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011242 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11243 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11244
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011245 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11246 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11247 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11248 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11249 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11250 and we fall back to load balancing.
11251
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011252 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011253
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011254
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100112555. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011256--------------------------
11257
11258The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11259depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11260settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11261written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11262described in this section.
11263
11264
112655.1. Bind options
11266-----------------
11267
11268The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11269as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11270no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11271parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11272while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11273provided immediately after the setting name.
11274
11275The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11276
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011277accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11278 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11279 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11280 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11281 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11282 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11283 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11284 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11285 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11286 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011287 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11288 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11289 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011290
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011291accept-proxy
11292 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011293 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11294 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011295 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11296 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11297 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11298 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011299 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011300 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11301 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011302 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11303 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011304
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011305allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011306 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011307 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011308 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011309 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11310 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011311
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011312alpn <protocols>
11313 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11314 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11315 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011316 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011317 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011318 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11319 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11320 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11321 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11322 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11323 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11324 preference, like below :
11325
11326 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011327
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011328backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011329 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011330 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11331
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011332curves <curves>
11333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11334 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11335 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11336 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11337 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11338 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11339
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011340ecdhe <named curve>
11341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011342 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11343 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011344
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011345ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11347 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11348 client's certificate.
11349
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011350ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11352 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11353 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11354 error is ignored.
11355
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011356ca-sign-file <cafile>
11357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11358 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11359 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11360 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11361 'generate-certificates' for details.
11362
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011363ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11365 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11366 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11367 'generate-certificates' for details.
11368
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011369ca-verify-file <cafile>
11370 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11371 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11372 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11373 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11374 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11375
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011376ciphers <ciphers>
11377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11378 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011379 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011380 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011381 information and recommendations see e.g.
11382 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11383 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11384 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11385
11386ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11388 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11389 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11390 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011391 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11392 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011393
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011394crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011395 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11396 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11397 to verify client's certificate.
11398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011399crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011400 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11401 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11402 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11403 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11404 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011405 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11406 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011407
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011408 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11409 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11410
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011411 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11412 are loaded.
11413
11414 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011415 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11416 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11417 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11418 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11419 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11420 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11421 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011422 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011423
11424 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11425 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11426 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11427 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011428 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11429 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011430
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011431 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011432
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011433 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011434 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011435 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11436 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011437 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11438 clients).
11439
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011440 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11441 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11442 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11443 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11444 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11445 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11446 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11447 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11448 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11449 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11450 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11451 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11452 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11453
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011454 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11455 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11456 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11457 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11458 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11459
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011460 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11461 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11462 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11463 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011464
11465 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11466 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11467 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11468 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11469 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11470 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11471 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11472 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11473 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11474
11475 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11476
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011477 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011478 a cert bundle.
11479
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011480 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011481 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11482 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11483 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11484 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11485 provide multi-cert support.
11486
11487 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11488
11489 Filename | CN | SAN
11490 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11491 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011492 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011493 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11494 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11495
11496 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11497 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11498 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11499 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011500 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11501 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11502 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011503
11504 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11505 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11506
11507 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11508 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11509 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11510
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011511crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011513 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011514 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011515 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011516
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011517crt-list <file>
11518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011519 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11520 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011521
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011522 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11523
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011524 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11525 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11526 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11527 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011528
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011529 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11530 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11531 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11532 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11533 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11534 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11535 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11536 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011537
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011538 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011539 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011540 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11541 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11542 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011543
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011544 crt-list file example:
11545 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011546 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011547 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011548 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011549
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011550defer-accept
11551 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11552 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11553 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011554 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011555 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11556 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11557 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11558 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11559 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11560 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11561 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11562
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011563expose-fd listeners
11564 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11565 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011566 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11567 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011568 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011569
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011570force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011571 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011572 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011573 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011574 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011575
11576force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011577 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011578 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011579 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011580
11581force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011582 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011583 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011584 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011585
11586force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011587 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011588 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011589 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011590
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011591force-tlsv13
11592 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11593 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011594 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011595
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011596generate-certificates
11597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11598 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11599 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11600 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11601 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11602 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11603 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11604 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11605 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11606 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11607 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11608
11609 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11610 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011611 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011612 certificate is used many times.
11613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011614gid <gid>
11615 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11616 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11617 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11618 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11619 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11620
11621group <group>
11622 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11623 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11624 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11625 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11626 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11627
11628id <id>
11629 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11630 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11631 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11632 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11633
11634interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011635 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11636 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11637 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11638 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11639 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11640 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011641 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11642 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11643 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11644 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11645 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11646 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011647
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011648level <level>
11649 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11650 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11651 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011652 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011653 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11654 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11655 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011656 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011657 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011658 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011659 all counters).
11660
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011661severity-output <format>
11662 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11663 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11664 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11665 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11666 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11667 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11668 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11669 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11670 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11671 rfc5424 convention.
11672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011673maxconn <maxconn>
11674 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11675 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11676 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11677 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11678 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11679 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11680 eat all memory.
11681
11682mode <mode>
11683 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11684 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11685 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11686 UNIX sockets.
11687
11688mss <maxseg>
11689 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11690 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11691 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11692 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11693 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11694 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11695 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11696 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11697 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11698 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11699 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11700
11701name <name>
11702 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11703 page.
11704
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011705namespace <name>
11706 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11707 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11708 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11709 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11710
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011711nice <nice>
11712 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11713 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11714 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11715 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11716 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11717 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11718 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11719 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11720 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11721 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11722 one for an RDP socket.
11723
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011724no-ca-names
11725 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11726 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011727 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011728
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011729no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011731 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011732 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011733 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011734 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11735 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011736
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011737no-tls-tickets
11738 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11739 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11740 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011741 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11742 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011743 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11744 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11745 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011746
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011747no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011749 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011750 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011751 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011752 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11753 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011754
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011755no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011757 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011758 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011759 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011760 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11761 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011762
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011763no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011764 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011765 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011766 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011767 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011768 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11769 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011770
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011771no-tlsv13
11772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11773 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11774 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11775 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011776 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11777 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011778
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011779npn <protocols>
11780 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11781 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11782 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011783 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011784 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011785 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11786 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11787 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11788 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11789 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011790
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011791prefer-client-ciphers
11792 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11793 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11794 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011795 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11796 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11797 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011798
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011799process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011800 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011801 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011802 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011803 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11804 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11805 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11806 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011807 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011808 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11809 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11810 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11811 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11812 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011813
11814 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11815
11816 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11817 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11818 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11819 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11820 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11821 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11822 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11823 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011824
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011825proto <name>
11826 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11827 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11828 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11829 in haproxy -vv.
11830 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11831 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011832 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011833 h2" on the bind line.
11834
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011835ssl
11836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011837 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011838 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11839 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011840 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11841 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011842
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011843ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11844 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11845 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11846 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11847
11848ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11849 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11850 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11851 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11852
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011853strict-sni
11854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11855 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11856 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11857 See the "crt" option for more information.
11858
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011859tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011860 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011861 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11862 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011863 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011864 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11865 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11866 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11867 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11868 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11869 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11870 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11871
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011872tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011873 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011874 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11875 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11876 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11877 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11878 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11879 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11880 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011881 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11882 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11883 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011884
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011885tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11886 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011887 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11888 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11889 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11890 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11891 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11892 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11893 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11894 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11895 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11896 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011897 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11898 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011900transparent
11901 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11902 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11903 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11904 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11905 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11906 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11907 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11908 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11909 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11910 so check for support with your vendor.
11911
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011912v4v6
11913 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11914 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11915 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11916 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011917 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011918
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011919v6only
11920 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11921 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11922 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011923 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11924 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011925
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011926uid <uid>
11927 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11928 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11929 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11930 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11931 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11932
11933user <user>
11934 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11935 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11936 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11937 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11938 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11939
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011940verify [none|optional|required]
11941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11942 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11943 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11944 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11945 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011946 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11947 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11948 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11949 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011950
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119515.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011952------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011954The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11955which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11956arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11957settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11958after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11959Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11960address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011962 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011963 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011964
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011965Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11966keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011968The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011969
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011970addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011971 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011972 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11973 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11974 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11975 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11976 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011977
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011978agent-check
11979 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011980 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011981 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11982 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11983 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011984
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011985 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011986 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011987 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11988 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11989 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011990
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011991 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11992 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11993 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11994 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11995 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011996
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011997 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011998 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011999
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012000 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12001 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12002 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012003
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012004 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12005 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12006 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012007
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012008 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12009 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12010 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12011 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12012 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012013 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012014 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012015
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012016 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12017 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012018
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012019 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12020 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12021 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12022 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12023 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12024 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12025 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12026 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12027 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012028
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012029 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12030 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012031 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12032 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12033 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012034 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012035
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012036 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012037 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012038
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012039agent-send <string>
12040 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12041 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12042 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12043 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12044 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12045
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012046agent-inter <delay>
12047 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12048 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12049
12050 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12051 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12052 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12053 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12054 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12055 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12056 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12057 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12058 of backends use the same servers.
12059
12060 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12061
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012062agent-addr <addr>
12063 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12064
12065 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12066 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12067 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12068 hostname, it will be resolved.
12069
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012070agent-port <port>
12071 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12072
12073 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12074
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012075allow-0rtt
12076 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012077 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12078 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012079
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012080alpn <protocols>
12081 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12082 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12083 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012084 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012085 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12086 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12087 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12088 now obsolete NPN extension.
12089 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12090 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12091
12092 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012094backup
12095 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12096 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12097 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12098 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012099 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12100 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012101
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012102ca-file <cafile>
12103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12104 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12105 server's certificate.
12106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012107check
12108 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012109 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12110 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12111 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12112 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12113 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12114 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12115 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012116 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12117 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012118 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12119 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012120
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012121check-send-proxy
12122 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12123 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12124 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12125 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12126 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12127 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12128 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12129
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012130check-alpn <protocols>
12131 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12132 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12133 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12134
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012135check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012136 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012137 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12138 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012139
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012140check-ssl
12141 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12142 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12143 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12144 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012145 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012146 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12147 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012148 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012149 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12150 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012151
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012152check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012153 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012154 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12155 for normal traffic.
12156
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012157ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12159 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12160 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012161 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12162 information and recommendations see e.g.
12163 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12164 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12165 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012166
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012167ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12168 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12169 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12170 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12171 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012172 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12173 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12174 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012176cookie <value>
12177 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12178 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12179 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12180 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12181 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12182 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12183 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12184
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012185crl-file <crlfile>
12186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12187 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12188 to verify server's certificate.
12189
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012190crt <cert>
12191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12192 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12193 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12194 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12195 certificate request.
12196
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012197disabled
12198 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12199 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12200 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12201 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12202 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012203 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012204
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012205enabled
12206 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12207 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12208 default value.
12209 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12210 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012212error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012213 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12214 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12215 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012217 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012219fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012220 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12221 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12222 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12223
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012224force-sslv3
12225 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12226 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012227 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012228 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012229
12230force-tlsv10
12231 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012232 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012233 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012234
12235force-tlsv11
12236 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012237 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012238 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012239
12240force-tlsv12
12241 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012242 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012243 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012244
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012245force-tlsv13
12246 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12247 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012248 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012250id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012251 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12252 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12253 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012254
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012255init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12256 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12257 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012258 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012259 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12260 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12261 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12262 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12263 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12264 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12265 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12266 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12267 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012268 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012269 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12270 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12271 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12272 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12273 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12274 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012275 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012276
12277 Example:
12278 defaults
12279 # never fail on address resolution
12280 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012282inter <delay>
12283fastinter <delay>
12284downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012285 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12286 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12287 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12288 between checks depending on the server state :
12289
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012290 Server state | Interval used
12291 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12292 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12293 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12294 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12295 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12296 or yet unchecked. |
12297 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12298 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12299 | "inter" otherwise.
12300 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012302 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12303 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12304 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12305 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012306 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12307 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12308 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12309 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12310 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012312maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012313 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12314 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012315 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12316 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012317 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12318 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12319 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12320 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12321
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012322 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12323 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12324 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12325 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12326 than 50 concurrent requests.
12327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012328maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012329 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12330 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12331 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12332 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12333 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12334 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12335 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12336
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012337max-reuse <count>
12338 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12339 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12340 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12341 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12342 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12343 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12344 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12345 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012347minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012348 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12349 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12350 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12351 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12352 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12353 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012354 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012355 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012356
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012357namespace <name>
12358 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12359 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12360 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12361 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12362
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012363no-agent-check
12364 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12365 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12366 default value.
12367 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12368 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12369
12370no-backup
12371 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12372 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12373 default value.
12374 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12375 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12376
12377no-check
12378 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12379 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12380 default value.
12381 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12382 "default-server" "check" setting.
12383
12384no-check-ssl
12385 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12386 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12387 default value.
12388 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12389 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12390
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012391no-send-proxy
12392 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12393 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12394 default value.
12395 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12396 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12397
12398no-send-proxy-v2
12399 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12400 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12401 default value.
12402 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12403 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12404
12405no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12406 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12407 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12408 default value.
12409 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12410 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12411
12412no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12413 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12414 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12415 default value.
12416 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12417 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12418
12419no-ssl
12420 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12421 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12422 default value.
12423 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12424 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12425
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012426no-ssl-reuse
12427 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12428 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12429 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12430 and for paranoid users.
12431
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012432no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012433 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12434 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012435 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012436
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012437 Supported in default-server: No
12438
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012439no-tls-tickets
12440 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12441 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12442 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012443 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12444 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012445 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12446 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12447 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012448 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012449
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012450no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012451 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012452 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12453 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012454 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12455 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012456 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012457
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012458 Supported in default-server: No
12459
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012460no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012461 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012462 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12463 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012464 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12465 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012466 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012467
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012468 Supported in default-server: No
12469
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012470no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012471 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012472 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12473 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012474 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12475 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012476 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012477
12478 Supported in default-server: No
12479
12480no-tlsv13
12481 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12482 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12483 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12484 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12485 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012486 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012487
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012488 Supported in default-server: No
12489
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012490no-verifyhost
12491 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12492 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12493 default value.
12494 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12495 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012496
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012497no-tfo
12498 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12499 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12500 default value.
12501 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12502 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12503
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012504non-stick
12505 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12506 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12507 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12508
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012509npn <protocols>
12510 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12511 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12512 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012513 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012514 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12515 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12516 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012518observe <mode>
12519 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12520 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12521 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12522 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12523 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12524 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012525 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012526
12527 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012529on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012530 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12531 Currently, four modes are available:
12532 - fastinter: force fastinter
12533 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12534 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12535 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12536 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12537
12538 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12539
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012540on-marked-down <action>
12541 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12542 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012543 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12544 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12545 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12546 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12547 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12548 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12549 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12550 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012551
12552 Actions are disabled by default
12553
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012554on-marked-up <action>
12555 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12556 Currently one action is available:
12557 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12558 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12559 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12560 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012561 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12562 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012563 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12564 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12565
12566 Actions are disabled by default
12567
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012568pool-max-conn <max>
12569 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12570 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12571 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12572 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12573 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12574 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12575
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012576pool-purge-delay <delay>
12577 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012578 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012579 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012581port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012582 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12583 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12584 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12585 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12586 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12587 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12588
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012589proto <name>
12590
12591 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12592 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12593 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12594 reported in haproxy -vv.
12595 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12596 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012598redir <prefix>
12599 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12600 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12601 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12602 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12603 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12604 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12605 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12606 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012607 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012608 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012609 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12610 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12611 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12612 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12613
12614 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012616rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012617 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12618 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12619 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12620
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012621resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12622 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12623 server.
12624
12625 Available options:
12626
12627 * allow-dup-ip
12628 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12629 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12630 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12631 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12632 For such case, simply enable this option.
12633 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12634
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012635 * ignore-weight
12636 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12637 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12638 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12639
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012640 * prevent-dup-ip
12641 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12642 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12643 same fqdn.
12644 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12645
12646 Example:
12647 backend b_myapp
12648 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12649 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12650 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12651
12652 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12653 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12654 it
12655 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12656 different address
12657
12658 Default value: not set
12659
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012660resolve-prefer <family>
12661 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12662 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12663 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12664 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12665
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012666 Default value: ipv6
12667
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012668 Example:
12669
12670 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012671
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012672resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012673 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012674 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012675 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012676 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12677 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012678 configured network, another address is selected.
12679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012680 Example:
12681
12682 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012683
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012684resolvers <id>
12685 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12686 hostname.
12687
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012688 Example:
12689
12690 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012691
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012692 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012693
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012694send-proxy
12695 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12696 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12697 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12698 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012699 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12700 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12701 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12702 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12703 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12704 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12705 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12706 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12707 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12708 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012709 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12710 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012711
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012712send-proxy-v2
12713 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12714 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12715 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12716 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012717 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12718 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12719 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12720 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012721
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012722proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010012723 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
12724 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
12725
12726 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
12727 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
12728 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
12729 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
12730 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
12731 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
12732 connection is supported).
12733 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
12734 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
12735 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
12736 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
12737 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
12738 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
12739 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012740
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012741send-proxy-v2-ssl
12742 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12743 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12744 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12745 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12746 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12747 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12748 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012749 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12750 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012751
12752send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12753 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12754 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12755 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12756 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12757 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12758 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12759 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12760 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012761 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12762 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012764slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012765 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12766 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12767 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12768 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12769 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12770 parameters :
12771
12772 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12773 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12774
12775 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12776 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12777 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12778 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12779
12780 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12781 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12782 seen as failed.
12783
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012784sni <expression>
12785 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12786 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12787 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12788 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012789 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12790 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012791 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012792 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12793 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012794
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012795source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012796source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012797source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012798 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12799 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12800 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12801 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12802
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012803 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12804 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12805 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12806 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12807 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12808 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12809 server.
12810
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012811 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12812 specifying the source address without port(s).
12813
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012814ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012815 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12816 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12817 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12818 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12819 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12820 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012821 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12822 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012823
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012824ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12825 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12826 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12827 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12828
12829ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12830 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12831 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12832 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12833
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012834ssl-reuse
12835 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12836 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12837 default value.
12838 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12839 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12840
12841stick
12842 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12843 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12844 default value.
12845 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12846 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012847
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012848socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012849 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012850 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12851 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12852
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012853tcp-ut <delay>
12854 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12855 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12856 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012857 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012858 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12859 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12860 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12861 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12862 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12863 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12864 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12865 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12866 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12867
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012868tfo
12869 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12870 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12871 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12872 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12873 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012874 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012876track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012877 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12878 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12879 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12880 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012881 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12882
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012883tls-tickets
12884 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12885 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12886 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012887 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12888 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12889 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012890 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012891 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012892
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012893verify [none|required]
12894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012895 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012896 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12897 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012898 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012899 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12900 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12901 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12902 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12903 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12904 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12905 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12906 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012907
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012908verifyhost <hostname>
12909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012910 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12911 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12912 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12913 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12914 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12915 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12916 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12917 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012918
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012919weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012920 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12921 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12922 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012923 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12924 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12925 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12926 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12927 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12928 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012929
12930
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129315.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12932-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012933
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012934HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12935using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12936configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012937This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12938can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12939workload.
12940This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12941resolution at run time.
12942Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12943carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12944
12945
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129465.3.1. Global overview
12947----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012948
12949As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12950different steps of the process life:
12951
12952 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12953 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12954 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12955
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012956 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12957 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012958
12959A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12960 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12961 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12962 resolution to know this new IP.
12963
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012964When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012965HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012966SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12967from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12968will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12969will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012970
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012971A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012972 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012973 first valid response.
12974
12975 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12976 servers return an error.
12977
12978
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129795.3.2. The resolvers section
12980----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012981
12982This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012983HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12984contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012985
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012986When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12987uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12988is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12989answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12990
12991When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012992used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012993
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012994 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12995 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12996 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012997
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012998 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12999 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013000
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013001 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13002 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13003 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013004
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013005For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13006following scenarios are possible:
13007
13008 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13009 ignored
13010
13011 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13012 applied
13013
13014 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13015 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13016
13017 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13018 retries the query with a new type
13019
13020 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13021 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013022
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013023As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13024a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013025<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013026
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013027
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013028resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013029 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013030
13031A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13032
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013033accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013034 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013035 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013036 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13037 by RFC 6891)
13038
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013039 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13040
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013041nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13042 DNS server description:
13043 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13044 <ip> : IP address of the server
13045 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13046
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013047parse-resolv-conf
13048 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13049 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13050 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13051
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013052hold <status> <period>
13053 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13054 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013055 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013056 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013057 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13058 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13059 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13060
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013061 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013062
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013063resolve_retries <nb>
13064 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13065 giving up.
13066 Default value: 3
13067
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013068 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13069 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13070 type.
13071
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013072timeout <event> <time>
13073 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13074 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13075 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013076 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13077 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013078 Default value: 1s
13079 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013080 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013081 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013082 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13083 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13084
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013085 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013086
13087 resolvers mydns
13088 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13089 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013090 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013091 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013092 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013093 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013094 hold other 30s
13095 hold refused 30s
13096 hold nx 30s
13097 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013098 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013099 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013100
13101
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200131026. Cache
13103---------
13104
13105HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13106(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13107RAM.
13108
13109The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13110this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13111
13112If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13113independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13114when we try to allocate a new one.
13115
13116The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13117
13118It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13119"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13120for more details.
13121
13122When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13123replaced by "<CACHE>".
13124
13125
131266.1. Limitation
13127----------------
13128
13129The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13130
13131- If the response is not a 200
13132- If the response contains a Vary header
13133- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13134- If the response is not cacheable
13135
13136- If the request is not a GET
13137- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13138- If the request contains an Authorization header
13139
13140
131416.2. Setup
13142-----------
13143
13144To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13145the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13146
13147
131486.2.1. Cache section
13149---------------------
13150
13151cache <name>
13152 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13153 size of cache is mandatory.
13154
13155total-max-size <megabytes>
13156 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13157 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13158
13159max-object-size <bytes>
13160 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13161 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13162 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13163
13164max-age <seconds>
13165 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13166 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13167 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13168 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13169 default.
13170
13171
131726.2.2. Proxy section
13173---------------------
13174
13175http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13176 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13177 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13178 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13179 after this one.
13180
13181http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13182 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13183 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13184 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13185 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13186
13187
13188Example:
13189
13190 backend bck1
13191 mode http
13192
13193 http-request cache-use foobar
13194 http-response cache-store foobar
13195 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13196
13197 cache foobar
13198 total-max-size 4
13199 max-age 240
13200
13201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132027. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13203----------------------------------
13204
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013205HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013206client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13207The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13208these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13209but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13210data called patterns.
13211
13212
132137.1. ACL basics
13214---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013215
13216The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13217content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13218from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13219simple :
13220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013221 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013222 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013223 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13224 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013226The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13227adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013228
13229In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013232
13233This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13234Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13235and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013236an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13237conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13238as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13239are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013240
13241ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13242'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13243which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13244
13245There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13246performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013248The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13249specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13250this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013251methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13252ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013253
13254Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13255 - boolean
13256 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13257 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13258 - string
13259 - data block
13260
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013261Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13262converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13263would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13264The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13265which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13266
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013267Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13268keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13269fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13270which are summarized in the table below :
13271
13272 +---------------------+-----------------+
13273 | Sample or converter | Default |
13274 | output type | matching method |
13275 +---------------------+-----------------+
13276 | boolean | bool |
13277 +---------------------+-----------------+
13278 | integer | int |
13279 +---------------------+-----------------+
13280 | ip | ip |
13281 +---------------------+-----------------+
13282 | string | str |
13283 +---------------------+-----------------+
13284 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13285 +---------------------+-----------------+
13286
13287Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13288matching method, see below.
13289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013290The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13291 - boolean
13292 - integer or integer range
13293 - IP address / network
13294 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13295 - regular expression
13296 - hex block
13297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013298The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13299
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013300 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13301 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013303 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013304 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013305 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013306 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13309read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13310if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13311lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13312will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13313beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13314a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13315lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13316exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13317
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013318The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13319parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13320ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13321a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13322check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13323
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013324The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13325socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13326file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013328Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13329loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13330
13331 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13332
13333In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13334the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13335case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13336as well.
13337
13338The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13339sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13340do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13341methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13342is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013343obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13345default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13346that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13347string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13348
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013349The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13350By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13351string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13352resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13353server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013354waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013355flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13356function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013358There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13359sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13360be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013361
13362 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13363 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013364 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13365 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13366 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13367 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013368
13369 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13370 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013371 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013372
13373 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013374 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013375
13376 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013378
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013379 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013380 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13381
13382 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13383 binary or string samples.
13384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013385 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13386 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013388 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13389 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13390 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13393 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013395 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13396 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13399 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013401 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13402 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013403 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13406 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13407 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013408
13409For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13410request, it is possible to do :
13411
13412 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13413
13414In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13415buffer, one would use the following acl :
13416
13417 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13418
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013419On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13420possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13421
13422 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013424All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13425criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13426method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13427to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13428criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13429the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013432the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13433For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13436 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13437 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13438 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013439
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013440
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013441The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13442types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13443combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13444brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13445default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 +-------------------------------------------------+
13448 | Input sample type |
13449 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013450 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13452 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13453 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013454 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013456 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013457 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013458 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013459 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013460 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013462 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013464 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013466 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013468 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013470 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013471 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013472 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013474 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013475 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13476 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13477 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013478
13479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134807.1.1. Matching booleans
13481------------------------
13482
13483In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13484Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13485When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13486that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13487
13488Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13489return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13490"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13491
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134937.1.2. Matching integers
13494------------------------
13495
13496Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13497enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13498to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13499
13500Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13501matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13502lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013503
13504For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13505unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13506representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13507
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013508As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13509two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13510instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13511ranges and operators.
13512
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013513For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013514operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13515Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13516of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013518Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013519
13520 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13521 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13522 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13523 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13524 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013526For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013527
13528 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13529
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013530This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13531
13532 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135357.1.3. Matching strings
13536-----------------------
13537
13538String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13539different forms :
13540
13541 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013542 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543
13544 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013545 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546
13547 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13548 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13549
13550 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13551 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13552
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013553 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13555 matches.
13556
13557 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13558 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13559 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013560
13561String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13562exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13563characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13564string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13565to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013566before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013567
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013568Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13569(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13570Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13571
13572Example:
13573 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13574 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13575
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135777.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13578---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013579
13580Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13581they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13582possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13583passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13584the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013585the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13586match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013587
13588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135897.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13590-------------------------------------
13591
13592It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13593not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13594a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13595to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13596digits may be used upper or lower case.
13597
13598Example :
13599 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13600 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13601
13602
136037.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13604---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013605
13606IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13607netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13608within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013609host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013610difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13611at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13612does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13613parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013614
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013615The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13616abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13617
13618 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13619 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13620 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13621 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13622 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13623 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13624 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13625 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13626
13627Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13628192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13629
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013630IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13631Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13632trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13633IPv6 patterns.
13634
13635HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13636following situations :
13637 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13638 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13639 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13640 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13641 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13642 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13643 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13644 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13645 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13646 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013648
136497.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13650----------------------------------
13651
13652Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13653combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13654
13655 - AND (implicit)
13656 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13657 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013659A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013661 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013663Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13664indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13667"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13668requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13669is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13670
13671 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013672 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13673 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13674 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013675
13676To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13677and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13678
13679 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13680 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13681 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13682 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13683
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013684 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013685 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13686 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13687 use_backend www if host_www
13688
13689It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13690expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13691be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13692the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13693
13694 The following rule :
13695
13696 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013697 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013698
13699 Can also be written that way :
13700
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013701 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013702
13703It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13704to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13705simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13706sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13707good use is the following :
13708
13709 With named ACLs :
13710
13711 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13712 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13713 monitor fail if site_dead
13714
13715 With anonymous ACLs :
13716
13717 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13718
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013719See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13720keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721
13722
137237.3. Fetching samples
13724---------------------
13725
13726Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13727against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13728sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13729ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13730of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13731available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13732
13733This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13734Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13735compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13736deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13737
13738The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13739matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13740method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13741indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13742
13743As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13744when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13745mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13746the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13747ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13748
13749Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13750multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13751when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13753are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013754is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13755all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13756
13757Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13758 - name
13759 - name(arg1)
13760 - name(arg1,arg2)
13761
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013762
137637.3.1. Converters
13764-----------------
13765
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013766Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13767of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13768is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13769was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013770has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013771unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13772
13773These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13774sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13775the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013776support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013777
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013778A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13779support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13780supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13781(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13782bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013784The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013785
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001378651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13787 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13788 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13789 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13790 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13791 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13792
13793 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013794 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13795 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013796 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13797 frontend http-in
13798 bind *:8081
13799 default_backend servers
13800 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13801 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13802
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013803add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013804 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013805 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013806 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13807 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13811 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13812 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013813 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013814 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013815
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013816aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13817 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13818 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13819 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13820 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13821 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13822 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13823
13824 Example:
13825 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13826 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13827
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013828and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013829 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013830 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013831 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13832 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013833 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013834 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13835 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13836 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13837 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013838 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013839 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013840
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013841b64dec
13842 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13843 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13844
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013845base64
13846 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013847 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013848 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13849
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013850bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013851 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013852 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013853 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013854 presence of a flag).
13855
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013856bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13857 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13858 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013859 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013860
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013861concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13862 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13863 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13864 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13865 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13866 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13867 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13868 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13869 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13870 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13871 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013872 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
13873 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
13874 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
13875 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013876
13877 Example:
13878 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13879 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13880 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013881 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013882 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13883
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013884cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013885 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13886 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013887
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013888crc32([<avalanche>])
13889 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13890 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13891 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13892 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13893 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13894 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13895 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13896 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13897 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13898 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013899 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13900
13901crc32c([<avalanche>])
13902 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13903 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13904 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13905 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13906 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13907 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13908 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13909 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013910
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013911da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013912 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13913 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13914 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13915 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013916 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013917 configuration language.
13918
13919 Example:
13920 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013921 bind *:8881
13922 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013923 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013924
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013925debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13926 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13927 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13928 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13929 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13930 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13931 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13932 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13933 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13934 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13935 printable sample types.
13936
13937 Example:
13938 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013939
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013940div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013941 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13942 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013943 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013944 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13945 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013946 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013947 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13948 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13949 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13950 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013952 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013953
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013954djb2([<avalanche>])
13955 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13956 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13957 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13958 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13959 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13960 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13961 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013962 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13963 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013964
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013965even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013966 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013967 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13968
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013969field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13970 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13971 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13972 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13973 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13974 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13975 fields.
13976
13977 Example :
13978 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13979 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13980 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13981 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13982 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013983
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013984hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013985 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013986 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013987 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013988 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013989
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013990hex2i
13991 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013992 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013993
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013994http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013995 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13996 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013997 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13998 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13999 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14000 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14001 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14002 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14003 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14004 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014005
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014006in_table(<table>)
14007 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14008 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14009 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014010 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014011 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14012
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014013ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14014 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014015 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014016 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14017 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14018 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14019 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14020 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014021
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014022json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014023 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014024 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014025 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014026 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14027 of errors:
14028 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14029 bytes, ...)
14030 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14031 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14032
14033 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14034 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14035 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14036 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14037 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14038 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014039 - "ascii" : never fails;
14040 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14041 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014042 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014043 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014044 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14045 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14046
14047 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014048 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014049
14050 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014051 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014052 capture request header user-agent len 150
14053 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014054
14055 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14056 GET / HTTP/1.0
14057 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14058
14059 Output log:
14060 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14061
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014062language(<value>[,<default>])
14063 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14064 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14065 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14066 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14067 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14068 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14069 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14070 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14071 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014072 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014073 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14074 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014075
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014076 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014077
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014078 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14079 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014080
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014081 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14082 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14083 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14084 use_backend spanish if es
14085 use_backend french if fr
14086 use_backend english if en
14087 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014088
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014089length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014090 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14091 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14092 type. The result is of type integer.
14093
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014094lower
14095 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14096 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14097 type. The result is of type string.
14098
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014099ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14100 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14101 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14102 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14103 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14104 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14105 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14106
14107 Example :
14108
14109 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014110 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014111 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14112
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014113map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14114map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14115map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14116 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14117 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14118 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14119 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14120 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14121 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14122 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14123 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014124
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014125 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14126 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14127 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014128
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014129 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014130 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014131
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014132 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14133 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14134 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14135 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014136 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14137 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014138 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14139 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14140 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14141 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14142 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14143 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14144 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14145 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014146 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14147 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14148 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014149 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14150 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14151 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14152 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14153 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014154
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014155 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14156 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14157 the corresponding match text.
14158
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014159 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14160 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14161 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14162 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14163 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014164
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014165 Example :
14166
14167 # this is a comment and is ignored
14168 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14169 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14170 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14171 | | | `---------- value
14172 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14173 | `---------------------------- key
14174 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14175
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014176mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014177 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14178 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014179 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014180 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014181 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014182 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14183 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14184 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14185 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014186 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014187 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014188
14189mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014190 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014191 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14192 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014193 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014194 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014195 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014196 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14197 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14198 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14199 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014200 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014201 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014202
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014203nbsrv
14204 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14205 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14206 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14207 map lookup.
14208
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014209neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014210 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14211 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14212 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14213 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014214
14215not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014216 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014217 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014218 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014219 absence of a flag).
14220
14221odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014222 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014223 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14224
14225or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014226 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014227 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014228 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14229 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014230 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014231 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14232 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14233 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14234 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014235 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014236 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014237
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014238protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14239 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14240 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14241 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14242 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14243 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14244 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14245 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14246 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14247 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14248 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14249 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14250
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014251regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014252 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14253 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14254 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14255 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14256 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14257 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14258 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14259 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14260 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014261 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14262 of characters with other ones.
14263
14264 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14265 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14266 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14267 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14268 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14269 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014270
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014271 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014272
14273 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14274 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14275 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014276 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014277
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014278 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14279 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14280
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014281 # capture groups and backreferences
14282 # both lines do the same.
14283 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14284 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14285
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014286capture-req(<id>)
14287 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14288 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14289
14290 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014291 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14292 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014293
14294capture-res(<id>)
14295 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14296 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14297
14298 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014299 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14300 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014301
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014302sdbm([<avalanche>])
14303 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14304 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14305 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14306 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14307 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14308 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14309 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014310 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14311 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014312
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014313set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014314 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14315 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14316 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014317 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014318 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14319 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014320 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014321 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14322 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014323 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014324 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014325
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014326sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014327 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014328 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14329
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014330sha2([<bits>])
14331 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14332 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14333
14334 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14335 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14336
14337 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14338 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14339
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014340srv_queue
14341 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14342 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14343 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14344 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14345 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14346
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014347strcmp(<var>)
14348 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14349 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14350 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14351 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14352 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14353 shorter).
14354
14355 Example :
14356
14357 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14358 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14359 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14360
14361
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014362sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014363 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14364 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014365 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014366 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14367 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014368 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014369 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14370 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014371 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014372 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14373 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014375 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014376
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014377table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14378 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14379 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14380 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14381 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14382 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14383 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14384
14385
14386table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14387 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14388 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14389 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14390 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14391 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14392 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14393
14394table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14395 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14396 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014397 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014398 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14399 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14400
14401table_conn_cur(<table>)
14402 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14403 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14404 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14405 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14406 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14407
14408table_conn_rate(<table>)
14409 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14410 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14411 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14412 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14413 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14414
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014415table_gpt0(<table>)
14416 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14417 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14418 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14419 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14420 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14421
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014422table_gpc0(<table>)
14423 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14424 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14425 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14426 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14427 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14428
14429table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14430 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14431 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14432 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14433 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14434 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14435 sample fetch keyword.
14436
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014437table_gpc1(<table>)
14438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14441 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14442 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14443
14444table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14445 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14446 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14447 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14448 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14449 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14450 sample fetch keyword.
14451
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014452table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014455 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014456 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14457 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14458
14459table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14460 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14461 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14462 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14463 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14464 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14465 keyword.
14466
14467table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14468 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14469 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014470 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014471 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14472 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14473
14474table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14475 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14476 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14477 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14478 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14479 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14480 keyword.
14481
14482table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014486 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14487 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14488 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14489 keyword.
14490
14491table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014494 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014495 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14496 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14497 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14498 keyword.
14499
14500table_server_id(<table>)
14501 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14502 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14503 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14504 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14505 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14506 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14507
14508table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14509 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14510 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014511 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014512 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14513 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14514 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14515 keyword.
14516
14517table_sess_rate(<table>)
14518 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14519 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14520 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14521 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14522 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14523 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14524 keyword.
14525
14526table_trackers(<table>)
14527 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14528 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14529 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14530 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14531 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14532 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14533 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14534 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14535 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14536 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14537
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014538upper
14539 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14540 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14541 type. The result is of type string.
14542
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014543url_dec
14544 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14545 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14546
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014547ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014548 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014549 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14550 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14551 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014552 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14553 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14554 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14555 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014556 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014557 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14558 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014559
14560 Example:
14561 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14562 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14563
14564 message Point {
14565 int32 latitude = 1;
14566 int32 longitude = 2;
14567 }
14568
14569 message PPoint {
14570 Point point = 59;
14571 }
14572
14573 message Rectangle {
14574 // One corner of the rectangle.
14575 PPoint lo = 48;
14576 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14577 PPoint hi = 49;
14578 }
14579
14580 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14581 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14582 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14583
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014584 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14585 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014586 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014587 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14588
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014589 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014590
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014591 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014592
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014593 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014594 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14595 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14596
14597 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14598 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14599 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14600
14601 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14602 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14603 interpret the previous binary sample.
14604
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014605
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014606unset-var(<var name>)
14607 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14608 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14609 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14610 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14611 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14612 response),
14613 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14614 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14615 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14616 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14617
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014618utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14619 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14620 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14621 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14622 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14623 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14624 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14625
14626 Example :
14627
14628 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014629 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014630 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14631
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014632word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14633 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14634 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14635 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014636 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014637 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14638 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14639
14640 Example :
14641 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14642 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14643 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14644 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14645 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014646 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014647
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014648wt6([<avalanche>])
14649 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14650 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14651 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14652 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14653 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14654 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14655 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014656 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14657 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014658
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014659xor(<value>)
14660 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014661 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014662 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014663 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014664 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014665 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14666 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014667 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014668 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14669 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014670 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014671 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014672
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014673xxh32([<seed>])
14674 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14675 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14676 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14677 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14678 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14679 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14680 as cryptographically secure.
14681
14682xxh64([<seed>])
14683 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14684 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14685 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14686 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14687 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14688 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14689 as cryptographically secure.
14690
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014691
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146927.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014693--------------------------------------------
14694
14695A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14696not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14697"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14698The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14699
14700always_false : boolean
14701 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14702 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14703
14704always_true : boolean
14705 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14706 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14707
14708avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014709 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014710 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14711 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14712 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14713 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14714 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14715 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14716 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14717 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14718 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14719 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14720 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14721 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14722 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014724be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014725 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14726 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14727 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14728 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014729 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14730
14731be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14732 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14733 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14734 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14735 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14736 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014737 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14738 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014739
14740 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14741 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14742 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014744be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14745 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14746 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14747 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014748 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014749 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14750 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014751
14752 Example :
14753 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14754 backend dynamic
14755 mode http
14756 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14757 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014758
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014759bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014760 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14761 of the string.
14762
14763bool(<bool>) : bool
14764 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14765 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14768 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014769 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14771 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014772
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014773 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014774 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014775 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14776
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014777 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14778 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014779
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014780 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014781 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014783 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014784 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014785 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014786 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014787
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014788 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14789 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014791 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014792
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014793cpu_calls : integer
14794 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14795 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14796 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14797 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14798 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14799 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14800
14801cpu_ns_avg : integer
14802 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14803 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14804 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14805 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14806 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14807 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14808 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14809 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14810 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14811 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14812 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14813
14814cpu_ns_tot : integer
14815 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14816 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14817 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14818 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14819 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14820 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14821 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14822 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14823 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14824 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14825 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14826 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14827 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14828
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014829date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014830 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014831
14832 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14833 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14834 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014835 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14836
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014837 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14838 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14839 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14840 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14841 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14842
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014843 Example :
14844
14845 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14846 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014847
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014848 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14849 # millisecond granularity
14850 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14851
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014852date_us : integer
14853 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14854 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14855 from the same timeval structure.
14856
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014857distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14858 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14859 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14860 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14861 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14862 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14863 list of supported tokens.
14864
14865distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14866 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14867 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14868 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14869 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14870 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14871 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14872 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14873 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14874 supported tokens.
14875
14876 Example :
14877 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14878 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14879 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14880 # send large files to the big farm
14881 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14882
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014883env(<name>) : string
14884 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14885 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14886 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14887 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14888 certain way.
14889
14890 Examples :
14891 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14892 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14893
14894 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14895 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14898 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014899 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14900 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014901 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14902 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014903 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014904 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14905 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014906
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014907fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14908 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14909 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14910 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14913 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14914 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14915 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14916 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14917 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14918 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14919 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14920 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014921
14922 Example :
14923 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14924 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14925 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14926 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14927 frontend mail
14928 bind :25
14929 mode tcp
14930 maxconn 100
14931 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14932 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14933 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14934 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014935
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014936hostname : string
14937 Returns the system hostname.
14938
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014939int(<integer>) : signed integer
14940 Returns a signed integer.
14941
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014942ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14943 Returns an ipv4.
14944
14945ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14946 Returns an ipv6.
14947
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014948lat_ns_avg : integer
14949 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14950 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14951 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14952 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14953 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14954 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14955 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14956 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14957 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14958 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14959 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14960 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14961 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14962 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14963
14964lat_ns_tot : integer
14965 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14966 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14967 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14968 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14969 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14970 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14971 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14972 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14973 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14974 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14975 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14976 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14977 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14978 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14979 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14980 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14981 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14982 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14983 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14984
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014985meth(<method>) : method
14986 Returns a method.
14987
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014988nbproc : integer
14989 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14990 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14991 and debugging purposes.
14992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14994 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14995 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14996 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014997 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14998 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14999 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015000
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015001prio_class : integer
15002 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15003 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15004 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15005
15006prio_offset : integer
15007 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15008 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15009 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15010 set-priority-offset".
15011
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015012proc : integer
15013 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15014 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15015 debugging purposes.
15016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015018 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15019 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15020 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015021 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15022 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15023 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15024 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15025 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15026
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015027rand([<range>]) : integer
15028 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15029 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15030 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15031 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15032 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15033
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015034uuid([<version>]) : string
15035 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15036 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15037 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015039srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15040 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15041 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15042 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15043 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15044 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015045 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15046 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15047
15048srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15049 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15050 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15051 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15052 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15053 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15054 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15055 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15056
15057 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15058 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059
15060srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15061 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15062 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15063 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015064 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015065 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15066 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15067 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15068
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015069srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15070 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15071 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15072 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15073 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15074 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15075 fetch methods.
15076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15078 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15079 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015080 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015081 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15082 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015083 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084 overloading servers).
15085
15086 Example :
15087 # Redirect to a separate back
15088 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15089 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15090 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15091
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015092stopping : boolean
15093 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15094 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15095 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15096
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015097str(<string>) : string
15098 Returns a string.
15099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015100table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15101 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15102 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15103
15104table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15105 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15106 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15107 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15108
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015109thread : integer
15110 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15111 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15112 and debugging purposes.
15113
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015114var(<var-name>) : undefined
15115 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015116 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15117 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015118 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015119 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15120 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015121 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015122 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15123 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015124 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015125 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015126
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151277.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128----------------------------------
15129
15130The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15131closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15132methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15133sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15134TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015135the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15136counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015137"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15138used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15139can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15140Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15141table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15142tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15143currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015144
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015145bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015146 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15147 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15148 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015150be_id : integer
15151 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15152 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15153
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015154be_name : string
15155 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15156 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015158dst : ip
15159 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15160 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15161 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15162 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015163 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15164 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15165 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15166 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15167 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15168 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015169
15170dst_conn : integer
15171 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15172 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15173 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15174 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15175 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15176 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15177 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15178 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015179
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015180dst_is_local : boolean
15181 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15182 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15183 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15184 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015185 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015186 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15187 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15188 it only once per connection.
15189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015190dst_port : integer
15191 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15192 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15193 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15194 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15195 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15196 an HTTP header.
15197
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015198fc_http_major : integer
15199 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15200 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15201 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15202
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015203fc_pp_authority : string
15204 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15205 if any.
15206
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015207fc_pp_unique_id : string
15208 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15209 if any.
15210
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015211fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15212 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15213 header.
15214
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015215fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15216 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15217 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15218 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15219 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15220 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15221 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15222
15223fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15224 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15225 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15226 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15227 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15228 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15229 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15230
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015231fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015232 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15233 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15234 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15235 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15236
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015237fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015238 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15239 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15240 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15241 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15242
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015243fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015244 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15245 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15246 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15247 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15248
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015249fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015250 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15251 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15252 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15253 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15254
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015255fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015256 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15257 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15258 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15259 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15260
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015261fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015262 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15263 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15264 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15265 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15266
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015267fe_defbe : string
15268 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15269 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015271fe_id : integer
15272 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015273 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15275
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015276fe_name : string
15277 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15278 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15279 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15280
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015281sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015282sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15283sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15284sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015285 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15286 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15287 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15288
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015289sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015290sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15291sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15292sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015293 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15294 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15295 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15296
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015297sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015298sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15299sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15300sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015301 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15302 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015303 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15304 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15305 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015306
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015307 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015308 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15309 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015310 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15311 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15312 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015313 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15314 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15315
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015316sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15317sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15318sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15319sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15320 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15321 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15322 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15323 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15324 when a first ACL was verified.
15325
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015326sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015327sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15328sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15329sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015330 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015331 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015333sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015334sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15335sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15336sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015337 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15338 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15339 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15340
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015341sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015342sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15343sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15344sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015345 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15346 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15347 See also src_conn_rate.
15348
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015349sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015350sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15351sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15352sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015353 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015354 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015355
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015356sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15357sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15358sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15359sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15360 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15361 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15362
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015363sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15364sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15365sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15366sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15367 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15368 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015370sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015371sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15372sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15373sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015374 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15375 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15376 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015377 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15378 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15379 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015380
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015381sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15382sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15383sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15384sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15385 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15386 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15387 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15388 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15389 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15390 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15391
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015392sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015393sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15394sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15395sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015396 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015397 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15398 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015400sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015401sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15402sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15403sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015404 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15405 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15406 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15407 src_http_err_rate.
15408
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015409sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015410sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15411sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15412sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015413 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015414 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15415 src_http_req_cnt.
15416
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015417sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015418sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15419sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15420sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015421 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15422 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15423 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15424 src_http_req_rate.
15425
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015426sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015427sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15428sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15429sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015430 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015431 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15432 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15433 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15434 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015435
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015436 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015437 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15438 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015439 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15440
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015441sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15442sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15443sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15444sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15445 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15446 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15447 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15448 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15449 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15450
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015451sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015452sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15453sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15454sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015455 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15456 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15457 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015458
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015459sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015460sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15461sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15462sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015463 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15464 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15465 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015466
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015467sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015468sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15469sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15470sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015471 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015472 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15473 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15474 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015475 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015476 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15477
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015478sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015479sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15480sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15481sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015482 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15483 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15484 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15485 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15486 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015487 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015488
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015489sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015490sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15491sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15492sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015493 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15494 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15495 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15496
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015497sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015498sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15499sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15500sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015501 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15502 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015503 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015504 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15505 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15507 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15508 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510so_id : integer
15511 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15512 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15513 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015514
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015515so_name : string
15516 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15517 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15518 strings instead of integers.
15519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015521 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15523 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15524 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015525 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15526 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15527 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015528 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15529 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15530 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15531 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15532 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15533 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15534 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015535
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015536 Example:
15537 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15538 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15541 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15542 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15543 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015544 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15547 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15548 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015549 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015550 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15553 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15554 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15555 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15556 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15557 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15558 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015559
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015560 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015561 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15562 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15563 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15564 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015565 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015566 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15567 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15568
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015569src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15570 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15571 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15572 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15573 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15574 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15575 was verified.
15576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015578 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015580 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015581 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015584 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15586 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015587 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15590 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15591 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15592 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015593 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015596 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015598 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015599 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015600
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015601src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15602 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15603 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15604 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15605 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15606
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015607src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15608 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15609 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15610 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15611 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015614 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015616 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15617 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015618 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15619 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15620 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015621
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015622src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15623 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15624 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15625 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15626 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15627 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15628 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15629 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015632 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015634 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015635 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015638src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15639 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15640 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15641 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15642 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015643 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015646 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15648 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015649 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15652 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15653 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15654 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015655 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015656 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15659 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15660 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15661 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015662 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15664 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015665
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015666 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015667 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015668 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015669 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015670
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015671src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15672 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15673 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15674 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15675 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15676 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15677 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15678
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015679src_is_local : boolean
15680 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15681 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15682 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15683 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015684 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015685 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15686 once per connection.
15687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015689 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15690 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15691 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15692 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15693 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015696 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15697 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15698 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15699 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15700 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702src_port : integer
15703 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15704 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15705 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15706 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015709 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015710 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15711 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15712 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015713 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15716 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15717 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15718 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15719 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015720 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15723 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15724 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15725 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15726 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15727 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15728 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15729 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15730 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015731
15732 Example :
15733 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15734 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15735 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15736 listen ssh
15737 bind :22
15738 mode tcp
15739 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015740 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015742 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744srv_id : integer
15745 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15746 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15747 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015748
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015749srv_name : string
15750 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15751 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15752 debugging.
15753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157547.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15758closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15759when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15760usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015761future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015762
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001576351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15764 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15765 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15766 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15767 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15768 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15769
15770 Example :
15771 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15772 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15773 # the request.
15774 frontend http-in
15775 bind *:8081
15776 default_backend servers
15777 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15778 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15779
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015780ssl_bc : boolean
15781 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15782 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15783 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15784
15785ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15786 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15787 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15788
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015789ssl_bc_alpn : string
15790 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15791 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015792 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015793 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15794 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15795 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15796 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15797 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15798 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15799
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015800ssl_bc_cipher : string
15801 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15802 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15803
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015804ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15805 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15806 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15807 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15808
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015809ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15810 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15811 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15812 session or a TLS ticket.
15813
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015814ssl_bc_npn : string
15815 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15816 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015817 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015818 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15819 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15820 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15821 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15822 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15823
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015824ssl_bc_protocol : string
15825 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15826 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15827
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015828ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015829 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015830 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15831 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015832
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015833ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15834 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15835 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15836 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15837
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015838ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15839 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15840 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15841 if session was reused or not.
15842
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015843ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15844 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15845 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15846 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15847 BoringSSL.
15848
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015849ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15850 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15851 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015853ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15854 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15855 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15856 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15857 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15858 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15861 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15862 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15863 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15864 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015865
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015866ssl_c_der : binary
15867 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15868 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15869 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871ssl_c_err : integer
15872 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15873 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15874 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15875 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15876 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015877
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015878ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015879 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15880 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15881 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15882 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15883 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15884 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15885 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15886 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015887 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15888 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15889 LDAP v3.
15890 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15891 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893ssl_c_key_alg : string
15894 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15895 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15896 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898ssl_c_notafter : string
15899 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15900 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15901 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903ssl_c_notbefore : string
15904 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15905 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15906 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015907
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015908ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15910 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15911 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15912 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15913 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15914 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15915 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15916 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015917 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15918 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15919 LDAP v3.
15920 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15921 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923ssl_c_serial : binary
15924 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15925 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15926 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15929 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15930 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15931 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015932 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15933 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15934
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015935 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015936 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15939 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15940 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15941 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943ssl_c_used : boolean
15944 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15945 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947ssl_c_verify : integer
15948 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15949 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15950 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15951 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953ssl_c_version : integer
15954 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15955 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015956
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015957ssl_f_der : binary
15958 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15959 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15960 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15961
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015962ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15964 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15965 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15966 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015967 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15969 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15970 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015971 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15972 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15973 LDAP v3.
15974 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15975 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977ssl_f_key_alg : string
15978 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15979 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15980 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982ssl_f_notafter : string
15983 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15984 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15985 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987ssl_f_notbefore : string
15988 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15989 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15990 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015991
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015992ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15994 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15995 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15996 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15997 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15998 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15999 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16000 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016001 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16002 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16003 LDAP v3.
16004 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16005 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007ssl_f_serial : binary
16008 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16009 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16010 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016011
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016012ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16013 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16014 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16015 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16018 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16019 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16020 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022ssl_f_version : integer
16023 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16024 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16025
16026ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016027 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16028 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16029 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031 Example :
16032 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16033 listen http-https
16034 bind :80
16035 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16036 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16037
16038ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16039 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16040 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16041
16042ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016043 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16045 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16046 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16047 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16048 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16049 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16050 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16051 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053ssl_fc_cipher : string
16054 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16055 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016056
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016057ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16058 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16059 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016060 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016061
16062ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16063 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16064 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016065 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016066
16067ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16068 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16069 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16070 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016071 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016072 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016073
16074ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16075 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16076 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016077 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016078
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016079ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16080 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16081 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16082 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016085 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16086 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016087 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16088 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16089 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16090 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016091
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016092ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16093 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16094 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16095 wait until the handshake happened.
16096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16098 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016099 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16100 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016101 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016102 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016103
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016104ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016105 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016106 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16107 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016110 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16112 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16113 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16114 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16115 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16116 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16117 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016119ssl_fc_protocol : string
16120 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16121 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016122
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016123ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016124 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016125 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16126 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016127
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016128ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16129 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16130 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16131 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16134 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16135 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16136 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16137 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016138
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016139ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16140 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16141 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16142 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16143 BoringSSL.
16144
16145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146ssl_fc_sni : string
16147 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16148 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16149 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16150 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16151 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16152
16153 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16154 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16155 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016156 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016157 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16161 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16164 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16165 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016166
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016167
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161687.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16172sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16173only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16174For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16175be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16176can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16177sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16178for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16179content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016182 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16184 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16187 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016188 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016190
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016191req.hdrs : string
16192 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16193 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16194 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16195 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16196
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016197req.hdrs_bin : binary
16198 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16199 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16200 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16201 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16202 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16203 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16204
16205 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16206
16207 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16208 str: <int:length><bytes>
16209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210req.len : integer
16211req_len : integer (deprecated)
16212 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16213 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16214 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16215 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16216 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16217 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16218 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16219 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016221req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16222 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016223 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16224 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16225 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16226 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 ACL alternatives :
16229 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16232 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16233 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16234 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16235 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 ACL alternatives :
16238 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016242req.proto_http : boolean
16243req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16244 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16245 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16246 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16247 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16248 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16249 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16250 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252 Example:
16253 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16254 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16255 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016256 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16259rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16260 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16261 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16262 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16263 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16264 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16265 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16266 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16269 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16270 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16271 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16272 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16273 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 ACL derivatives :
16276 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 Example :
16279 listen tse-farm
16280 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16281 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16282 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16283 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16284 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16285 persist rdp-cookie
16286 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16287 # This is only useful makes sense if
16288 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16289 stick-table type string size 204800
16290 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16291 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16292 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16295 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016297req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16298rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16299 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16300 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16301 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16302 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016304 ACL derivatives :
16305 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016306
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016307req.ssl_alpn : string
16308 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16309 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16310 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16311 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16312 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16313 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016314 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016315
16316 Examples :
16317 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16318 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16319 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016320 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016321 default_backend bk_default
16322
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016323req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16324 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16325 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016326 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16327 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16328 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16329 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16330 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016332req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16333req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16334 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16335 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16336 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16337 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16338 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16339 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16340 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342req.ssl_sni : string
16343req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16344 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16345 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16346 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16347 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16348 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16349 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16350 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16351 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16352 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16353 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16354 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16355 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016357 ACL derivatives :
16358 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360 Examples :
16361 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16362 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16363 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16364 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16365 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016366
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016367req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16368 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16369 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16370 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16371 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16372 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16373 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16374 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16375 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16376 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016378req.ssl_ver : integer
16379req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16380 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16381 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16382 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16383 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16384 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16385 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16386 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016387 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390 ACL derivatives :
16391 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016392
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016393res.len : integer
16394 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16395 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16396 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16397 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16398 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16399 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16400 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16401 content inspection.
16402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016403res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16404 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016405 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16406 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16407 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16408 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016410res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16411 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16412 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16413 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16414 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016416 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016417
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016418res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16419rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16420 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16421 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16422 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16423 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16424 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16425 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16426 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016428wait_end : boolean
16429 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16430 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016431 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016432 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16433 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016434 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16436 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438 Examples :
16439 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16440 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16441 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016443 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16444 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16445 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16446 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16447 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16448 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16449 tcp-request content reject
16450
16451
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164527.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016453--------------------------------------
16454
16455It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16456This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16457data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16458its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16459HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16460content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16461to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16462more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16463response are indexed.
16464
16465base : string
16466 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16467 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16468 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16469 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16470 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16471 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16472 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16473 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16474
16475 ACL derivatives :
16476 base : exact string match
16477 base_beg : prefix match
16478 base_dir : subdir match
16479 base_dom : domain match
16480 base_end : suffix match
16481 base_len : length match
16482 base_reg : regex match
16483 base_sub : substring match
16484
16485base32 : integer
16486 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16487 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16488 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016489 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16490 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16491 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492
16493base32+src : binary
16494 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16495 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16496 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16497 per-URL counters.
16498
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016499capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16500 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16501 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16502 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16503
16504capture.req.method : string
16505 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16506 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16507 because it's allocated.
16508
16509capture.req.uri : string
16510 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16511 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16512 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16513 allocated.
16514
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016515capture.req.ver : string
16516 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16517 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16518 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16519
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016520capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16521 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16522 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16523 The first entry is an index of 0.
16524 See also: "capture response header"
16525
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016526capture.res.ver : string
16527 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16528 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16529 persistent flag.
16530
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016531req.body : binary
16532 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16533 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16534 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16535 the first chunk is analyzed.
16536
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016537req.body_param([<name>) : string
16538 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16539 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16540 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16541 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16542 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16543 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16544 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16545 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16546 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16547 given.
16548
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016549req.body_len : integer
16550 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16551 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16552 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16553 "option http-buffer-request".
16554
16555req.body_size : integer
16556 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16557 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16558 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16559 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16560 "option http-buffer-request".
16561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562req.cook([<name>]) : string
16563cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16564 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16565 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16566 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16567 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16568 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16569 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16570 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16571 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16572
16573 ACL derivatives :
16574 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16575 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16576 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16577 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16578 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16579 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16580 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16581 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016583req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16584cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16585 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16586 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016588req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16589cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16590 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16591 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16592 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16593 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16596 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16597 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16598 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16599 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016600 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016601 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16602 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16603 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16604 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16607 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16608 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16609 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16610 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016611 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016613req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16614 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16615 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16616 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16617 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16618 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16619 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16620 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16621 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16624 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16625 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16626 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16627 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016629req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16630 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16631 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16632 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16633 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16634 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16635 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16636 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16637 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016638 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016639 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016640 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016642 ACL derivatives :
16643 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16644 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16645 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16646 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16647 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16648 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16649 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16650 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16651
16652req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16653hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16654 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16655 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16656 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16657 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16658 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16659 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16660 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16661 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16662 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16663
16664req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16665hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16666 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16667 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16668 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16669 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16670 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016671 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16673 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16674
16675req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16676hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16677 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16678 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16679 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16680 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16681 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16682 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16683 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16684
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016685
16686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016687http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16688 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16689 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16690 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16691 basic auth is supported.
16692
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016693http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16694 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16695 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16696 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16697 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16699 basic auth is supported.
16700
16701 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016702 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16703 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16704 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16705 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016706
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016707http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016708 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16709 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16710 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016711
16712http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016713 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16714 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16715 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016716
16717http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016718 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16719 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16720 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016722http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016723 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16724 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016725 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16726 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728method : integer + string
16729 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16730 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16731 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16732 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16733 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16734 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16735 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016737 ACL derivatives :
16738 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016740 Example :
16741 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16742 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16743 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016745path : string
16746 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16747 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16748 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16749 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16750 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016751 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016752 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754 ACL derivatives :
16755 path : exact string match
16756 path_beg : prefix match
16757 path_dir : subdir match
16758 path_dom : domain match
16759 path_end : suffix match
16760 path_len : length match
16761 path_reg : regex match
16762 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016763
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016764query : string
16765 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16766 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16767 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16768 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016769 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016770 which stops before the question mark.
16771
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016772req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16773 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16774 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16775 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16776 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778req.ver : string
16779req_ver : string (deprecated)
16780 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16781 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16782 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016784 ACL derivatives :
16785 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016787res.comp : boolean
16788 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16789 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16790 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016792res.comp_algo : string
16793 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16794 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16795 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797res.cook([<name>]) : string
16798scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16799 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16800 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16801 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803 ACL derivatives :
16804 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16807scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16808 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16809 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16810 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016812res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16813scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16814 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16815 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16816 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16819 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16820 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16821 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16822 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16823 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16824 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16825 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16826 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16827 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016829res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16830 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16831 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16832 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16833 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16834 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016836res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16837shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16838 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16839 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16840 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16841 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16842 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16843 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16844 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16845 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016847 ACL derivatives :
16848 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16849 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16850 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16851 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16852 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16853 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16854 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16855 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16856
16857res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16858shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16859 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16860 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16861 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16862 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16863 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016865res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16866shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16867 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16868 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16869 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16870 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16871 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16872 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016873
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016874res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16875 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16876 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16877 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16878 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016880res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16881shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16882 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16883 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16884 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16885 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16886 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16887 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889res.ver : string
16890resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16891 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16892 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894 ACL derivatives :
16895 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016897set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16898 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16899 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016900 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016901 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016903 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16904 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016906status : integer
16907 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16908 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16909 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016910
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016911unique-id : string
16912 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16913 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16914 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16915 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16916 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16917 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919url : string
16920 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16921 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16922 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16923 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16924 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16925 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16926 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016928 ACL derivatives :
16929 url : exact string match
16930 url_beg : prefix match
16931 url_dir : subdir match
16932 url_dom : domain match
16933 url_end : suffix match
16934 url_len : length match
16935 url_reg : regex match
16936 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938url_ip : ip
16939 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16940 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16941 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16942 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16943 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16944 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16945 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016947url_port : integer
16948 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16949 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16950 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16951 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016952
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016953urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16954url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016955 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16956 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016957 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16958 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16959 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16960 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016961 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16962 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016963 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16964 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016966 ACL derivatives :
16967 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16968 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16969 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16970 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16971 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16972 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16973 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16974 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016975
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016977 Example :
16978 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16979 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16980 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16981 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016982
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016983urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016984 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16985 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16986 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016987
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016988url32 : integer
16989 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16990 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16991 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16992 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16993 is an unsigned integer.
16994
16995url32+src : binary
16996 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16997 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16998 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16999
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017000
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100170017.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
17002---------------------------------------
17003
17004This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17005used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17006purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17007There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17008or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17009any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17010for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17011
17012internal.htx.data : integer
17013 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17014 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17015
17016internal.htx.free : integer
17017 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17018 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17019
17020internal.htx.free_data : integer
17021 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17022 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17023
17024internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17025 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17026 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17027 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17028
17029internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17030 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17031 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17032
17033internal.htx.size : integer
17034 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17035 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17036
17037internal.htx.used : integer
17038 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17039 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17040 direction.
17041
17042internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17043 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17044 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17045 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17046 of the special value :
17047 * head : The oldest inserted block
17048 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017049 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017050
17051internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17052 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17053 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17054 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17055 integer or one of the special value :
17056 * head : The oldest inserted block
17057 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017058 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017059
17060internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17061 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17062 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17063 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17064 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17065
17066 * head : The oldest inserted block
17067 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017068 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017069
17070internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17071 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17072 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17073 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17074 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17075
17076 * head : The oldest inserted block
17077 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017078 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017079
17080internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17081 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17082 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17083 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17084 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17085
17086 * head : The oldest inserted block
17087 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017088 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017089
17090internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17091 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17092 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17093 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17094 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17095
17096 * head : The oldest inserted block
17097 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017098 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017099
17100internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17101 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17102 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17103 it returns false.
17104
17105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171067.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017107---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017109Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17110every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017111order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017113ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17114---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017115FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017116HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017117HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17118HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017119HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17120HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17121HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17122HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17123LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017124METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017125METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017126METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17127METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17128METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17129METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017130METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017131METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017132RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017133REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017134TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017135WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17136---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017137
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171398. Logging
17140----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017141
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017142One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17143provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17144very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17145provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17146state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017147to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017148headers.
17149
17150In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17151about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17152send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17153
17154 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17155 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17156 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17157 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17158 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017159 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017160 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017161
17162The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17163allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17164as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17165while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17166real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17167delay.
17168
17169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171708.1. Log levels
17171---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017172
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017173TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017174source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017175HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17176in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17177track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17178syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17179about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017180
17181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171828.2. Log formats
17183----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017184
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017185HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017186and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17187slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17188options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017189
17190 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17191 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17192 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17193 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17194 extents.
17195
17196 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17197 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17198 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17199 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17200 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17201
17202 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17203 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17204 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17205 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17206 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17207
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017208 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17209 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17210 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17211 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17212
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017213 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17214
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017215Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17216specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17217field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17218servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17219always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17220identifier.
17221
17222Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17223 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17224 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17225 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17226 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17227
17228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172298.2.1. Default log format
17230-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017231
17232This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17233as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17234format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17235
17236 Example :
17237 listen www
17238 mode http
17239 log global
17240 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17241
17242 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17243 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17244 (www/HTTP)
17245
17246 Field Format Extract from the example above
17247 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17248 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17249 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17250 4 'to' to
17251 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17252 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17253
17254Detailed fields description :
17255 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17256 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17257 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17258 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17259 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17260 and processed the connection.
17261 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17262
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017263In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17264"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17265connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17266
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017267It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17268will eventually disappear.
17269
17270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172718.2.2. TCP log format
17272---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017273
17274The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17275is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17276information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17277counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17278emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17279environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17280the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17281sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017282specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17283not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17284fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17285marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017286
17287 Example :
17288 frontend fnt
17289 mode tcp
17290 option tcplog
17291 log global
17292 default_backend bck
17293
17294 backend bck
17295 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17296
17297 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17298 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17299 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17300
17301 Field Format Extract from the example above
17302 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17303 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17304 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17305 4 frontend_name fnt
17306 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17307 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17308 7 bytes_read* 212
17309 8 termination_state --
17310 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17311 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17312
17313Detailed fields description :
17314 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017315 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17316 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17317 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017318 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017319 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017320 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017321
17322 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017323 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17324 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17325 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017326
17327 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17328 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17329 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017330 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17331 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17332 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17333 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017334
17335 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17336 and processed the connection.
17337
17338 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17339 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17340 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17341 applications.
17342
17343 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17344 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17345 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17346 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17347 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17348
17349 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17350 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17351 See "Timers" below for more details.
17352
17353 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17354 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17355 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17356 "Timers" below for more details.
17357
17358 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017359 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017360 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17361 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17362 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17363 details.
17364
17365 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17366 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17367 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17368 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17369 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17370
17371 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17372 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17373 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17374 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17375 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17376 for more details.
17377
17378 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017379 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017380 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17381 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17382 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017383 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017384
17385 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17386 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17387 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17388 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17389 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17390 caused by a denial of service attack.
17391
17392 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17393 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17394 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17395 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17396 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17397 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17398 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17399 denial of service attack.
17400
17401 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17402 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17403 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17404 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17405 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17406 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17407 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17408 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17409 be processed than on other servers.
17410
17411 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17412 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17413 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17414 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17415 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17416 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17417 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17418 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17419 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17420 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17421 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17422 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17423 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17424
17425 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17426 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17427 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17428 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17429 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17430 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017431 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017432 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17433
17434 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17435 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17436 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17437 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17438 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17439 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017440 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017441 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17442 occurs.
17443
17444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174458.2.3. HTTP log format
17446----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017447
17448The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17449is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17450the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17451are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17452emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17453generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17454"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17455which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017456frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17457is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017458
17459Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17460slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17461with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17462
17463 Example :
17464 frontend http-in
17465 mode http
17466 option httplog
17467 log global
17468 default_backend bck
17469
17470 backend static
17471 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17472
17473 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17474 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17475 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017476 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477
17478 Field Format Extract from the example above
17479 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17480 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017481 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017482 4 frontend_name http-in
17483 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017484 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017485 7 status_code 200
17486 8 bytes_read* 2750
17487 9 captured_request_cookie -
17488 10 captured_response_cookie -
17489 11 termination_state ----
17490 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17491 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17492 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17493 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17494 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017495
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496Detailed fields description :
17497 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017498 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17499 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17500 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017501 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017502 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017503 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017504
17505 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017506 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17507 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17508 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017509
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017510 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17511 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017512
17513 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17514 and processed the connection.
17515
17516 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17517 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17518 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17519
17520 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17521 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17522 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17523 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17524 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17525 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17526
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017527 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17528 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17529 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017530 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017531 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17532 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017533 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17534 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017535
17536 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17537 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017538 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017539
17540 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17541 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017542 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17543 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544
17545 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17546 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17547 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17548 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17549 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017550 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17551 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017552
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017553 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17554 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17555 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17556 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17557 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17558 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17559 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017560 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017561
17562 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17563 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17564 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17565
17566 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17567 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017568 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017569 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17570 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17571 overflowing.
17572
17573 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17574 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17575 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17576 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17577 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17578 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17579 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17580 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17581
17582 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17583 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17584 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17585 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17586 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17587 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17588 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17589 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17590
17591 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17592 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17593 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17594 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17595 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17596 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17597 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17598
17599 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017600 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017601 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17602 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17603 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017604 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017605 system.
17606
17607 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17608 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17609 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17610 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17611 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17612 caused by a denial of service attack.
17613
17614 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17615 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17616 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17617 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17618 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17619 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17620 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17621 denial of service attack.
17622
17623 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17624 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17625 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17626 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17627 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17628 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17629 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17630 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17631 processed than on other servers.
17632
17633 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17634 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17635 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17636 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17637 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17638 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17639 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17640 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17641 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17642 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17643 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17644 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17645 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17646
17647 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17648 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17649 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17650 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17651 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17652 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017653 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017654 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17655
17656 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17657 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17658 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17659 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17660 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17661 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017662 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017663 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17664 occurs.
17665
17666 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17667 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17668 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17669 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17670 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17671 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17672 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17673 cookies" below for more details.
17674
17675 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17676 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17677 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17678 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17679 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17680 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17681 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17682 and cookies" below for more details.
17683
17684 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17685 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17686 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17687 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17688 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17689 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17690 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17691 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17692
17693
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200176948.2.4. Custom log format
17695------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017696
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017697The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017698mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017699
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017700HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017701Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17702separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17703prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17704
17705Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17706variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017707("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017708
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017709If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017710as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017711less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17712the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17713
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017714Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017715In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017716in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017717
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017718Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17719'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17720https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17721such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17722
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017723Flags are :
17724 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017725 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017726 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17727 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017728
17729 Example:
17730
17731 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17732 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17733
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017734 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17735
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017736At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17737
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017738 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17739 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017740
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017741the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017742
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017743 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17744 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17745 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017746
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017747and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17748
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017749 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17750 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017751
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017752Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17753
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017754 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017755 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017756 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17757 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17758 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017759 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17760 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17761 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017762 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017763 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17764 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017765 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017766 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17767 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017768 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017769 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017770 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017771 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017772 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017773 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017774 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017775 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17776 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17777 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17778 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17779 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017780 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017781 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17782 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017783 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017784 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17785 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017786 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17787 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17788 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017789 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017790 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17791 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017792 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017793 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17794 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17795 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017796 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017797 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017798 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17799 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17800 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17801 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017802 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017803 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017804 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017805 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017806 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017807 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017808 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17809 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17810 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017811 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017812 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17813 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017814 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017815 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17816 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017817 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017818 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017819 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017820 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017821
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017822 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017823
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017824
178258.2.5. Error log format
17826-----------------------
17827
17828When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17829protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17830By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17831"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017832will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017833logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17834
17835The format looks like this :
17836
17837 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17838 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17839 Connection error during SSL handshake
17840
17841 Field Format Extract from the example above
17842 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17843 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17844 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17845 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17846 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17847
17848These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17849failures.
17850
17851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178528.3. Advanced logging options
17853-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017854
17855Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17856just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17857options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17858for more information about their usage.
17859
17860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178618.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17862------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017863
17864It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17865haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17866commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17867monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17868ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17869
17870 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17871 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17872 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17873 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17874
17875 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17876 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17877 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017878 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017879 such as other load-balancers.
17880
17881 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17882 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17883 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17884
17885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178868.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17887----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017888
17889The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17890what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17891or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017892"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017893just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17894log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17895after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17896is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17897with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17898with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17899
17900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179018.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17902------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017903
17904Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17905for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17906"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17907retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17908raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17909a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17910file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17911you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17912"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17913
17914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179158.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17916--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017917
17918Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17919multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17920them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17921"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17922logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17923error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17924and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17925too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17926useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17927alternative.
17928
17929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179308.4. Timing events
17931------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017932
17933Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17934reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17935the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17936frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017937mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17938addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17939
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017940Timings events in HTTP mode:
17941
17942 first request 2nd request
17943 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17944 t tr t tr ...
17945 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17946 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17947 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17948 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17949 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17950
17951Timings events in TCP mode:
17952
17953 TCP session
17954 |<----------------->|
17955 t t
17956 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17957 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17958 |<------ Tt ------->|
17959
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017960 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017961 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017962 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17963 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17964 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017965 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017966 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17967 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17968 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17969 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017970
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017971 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17972 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17973 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017974 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17975 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17976 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17977 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17978 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17979 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017980
17981 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17982 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17983 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17984 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17985 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17986 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17987 request typed by hand during a test.
17988
17989 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17990 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017991 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017992 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17993 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17994 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17995 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017996
17997 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17998 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17999 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18000 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18001 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18002
18003 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18004 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18005 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18006 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18007 connection never established.
18008
18009 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18010 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18011 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18012 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18013 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18014 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18015 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18016 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18017 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18018 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18019 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18020
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018021 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18022 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18023 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18024 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18025 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18026 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18027
18028 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18029
18030 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18031 "Ta" can never be negative.
18032
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018033 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18034 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018035 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18036 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018037 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018038
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018039 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018040
18041 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018042 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18043 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018044
18045These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18046protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18047that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018048due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18049"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18050that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018051
18052Most common cases :
18053
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018054 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18055 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18056 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18057 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18058 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18059 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18060 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18061 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18062 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18063 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18064 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018065 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018066
18067 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18068 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18069 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18070 of ms on remote networks.
18071
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018072 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18073 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18074 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018075
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018076 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18077 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18078 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18079 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18080 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18081 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18082 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18083 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18084 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018085
18086Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18087
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018088 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018089 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018090 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018091
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018092 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018093 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18094 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18095
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018096 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018097 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18098 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18099 flags.
18100
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018101 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18102 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18104 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18105 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18106 the client connection was maintained open.
18107
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018108 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018109 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018110 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018111 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18112
18113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181148.5. Session state at disconnection
18115-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018116
18117TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18118"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
181192-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18120each of which has a special meaning :
18121
18122 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18123 session to terminate :
18124
18125 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18126
18127 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18128 server explicitly refused it.
18129
18130 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18131 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18132 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18133 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018134 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018135
18136 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18137 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018138
18139 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18140 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18141 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18142 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18143 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18144
18145 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18146 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18147 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18148 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18149 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18150
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018151 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18152 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18153
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018154 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18155 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18156 backup connections when going up.
18157
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018158 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18159
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018160 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18161 send or receive data.
18162
18163 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18164 send or receive data.
18165
18166 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18167 with nothing left in the buffers.
18168
18169 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18170
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018171 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018172 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18173
18174 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18175 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18176 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18177 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18178 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18179
18180 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18181 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18182
18183 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18184 server (HTTP only).
18185
18186 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18187
18188 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18189 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18190 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18191
18192 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18193 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18194 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18195
18196 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18197
18198 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18199 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18200
18201 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18202 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18203 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18204
18205 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18206 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018207 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18208 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018209
18210 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18211 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18212 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18213 another server.
18214
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018215 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018216 server.
18217
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018218 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18219 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18220 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18221 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18222
18223 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18224 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18225 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18226 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18227
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018228 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18229 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18230 "use-server" rule).
18231
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018232 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18233
18234 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18235 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18236
18237 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18238
18239 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18240 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18241 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18242
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018243 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18244 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018245 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018246 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18247 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18248
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018249 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18250
18251 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18252 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18253
18254 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18255
18256 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18257
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018258The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18259was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018260helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18261starvation, attacks, etc...
18262
18263The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18264alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18265easier finding and understanding.
18266
18267 Flags Reason
18268
18269 -- Normal termination.
18270
18271 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18272 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18273 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18274 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18275
18276 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18277 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18278 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18279 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18280 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18281 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018282
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018283 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18284 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018285 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018286
18287 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18288 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18289 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18290
18291 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18292 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18293 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18294 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18295 the server takes too long to respond.
18296
18297 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18298 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18299 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18300 long a time to respond.
18301
18302 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18303 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18304 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18305 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018306 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18307 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018308
18309 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18310 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18311 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18312 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18313 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018314 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018315 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18316 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18317 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18318 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18319 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18320 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18321 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18322 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018323 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018324 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18325 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18326 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018327
18328 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18329 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018330 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18331 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18332 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18333 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018334
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018335 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18336 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018338 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018339 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18340 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018341 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018342 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18343 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18344
18345 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18346 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18347 503 or 504 here.
18348
18349 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18350 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18351 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18352 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18353 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18354
18355 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18356 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018357 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018358 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18359 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18360
18361 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18362 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18363 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18364 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18365 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18366 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18367 between haproxy and the server.
18368
18369 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18370 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18371 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18372 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18373 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18374 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18375 solution is to fix the application.
18376
18377 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18378 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18379 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18380 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18381 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18382 external attacks.
18383
18384 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18385 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018386 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018387 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18388 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18389
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018390 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18391 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18392 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018393 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018394 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018396 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18397 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18398 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18399 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018400 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18401 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18402 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18403 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18404 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018405
18406 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18407 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18408 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18409 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18410
18411 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18412 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18413 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18414 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18415
18416 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18417 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18418 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18419 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18420
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018421The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18422persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18423important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18424re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18425
18426 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18427
18428 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18429 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18430 set on a GET request.
18431
18432 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18433 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018434 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018435 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18436
18437 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18438 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18439 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18440
18441 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18442 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18443 already got a cookie.
18444
18445 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18446 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18447 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18448 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18449 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18450
18451 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18452 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18453 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18454
18455 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18456 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18457 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18458
18459 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18460 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18461
18462 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18463 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18464 then advertised in the response.
18465
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184678.6. Non-printable characters
18468-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018469
18470In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18471consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18472converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18473prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18474being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18475escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18476is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18477'}' when logging headers.
18478
18479Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18480issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18481containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18482
18483Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18484the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18485performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18486
18487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18489---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018490
18491Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18492achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018493section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018494cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18495the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18496the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018497locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018498not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18499user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18500a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18501wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18502
18503 Examples :
18504 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18505 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18506
18507 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18508 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18509
18510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18512---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018513
18514Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18515proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18516the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18517server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18518
18519Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18520response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018521section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018522
18523It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018524time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18525appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018526are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18527and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18528follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18529request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18530in the logs.
18531
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018532As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18533frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18534an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18535
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018536 Example :
18537 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18538 listen proxy-out
18539 mode http
18540 option httplog
18541 option logasap
18542 log global
18543 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18544
18545 # log the name of the virtual server
18546 capture request header Host len 20
18547
18548 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18549 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18550
18551 # log the beginning of the referrer
18552 capture request header Referer len 20
18553
18554 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18555 capture response header Server len 20
18556
18557 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18558 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18559
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018560 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018561 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18562
18563 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18564 capture response header Via len 20
18565
18566 # log the URL location during a redirection
18567 capture response header Location len 20
18568
18569 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18570 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18571 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18572 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18573 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18574
18575 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18576 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18577 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18578 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018579 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018580
18581 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18582 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18583 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18584 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18585 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018586 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018587
18588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185898.9. Examples of logs
18590---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018591
18592These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18593them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18594reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18595
18596 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18597 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18598 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18599
18600 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18601 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18602
18603 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18604 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18605 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18606
18607 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18608 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18609
18610 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18611 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18612 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18613
18614 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018615 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018616 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18617 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18618
18619 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18620 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18621 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18622
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018623 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18624 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18625 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18626 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18627 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18628 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018629
18630 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018631 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018632
18633 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18634 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18635 Nothing was sent to any server.
18636
18637 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18638 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18639
18640 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18641 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018642 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018643 send a 408 return code to the client.
18644
18645 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18646 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18647
18648 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18649 5 seconds ("c----").
18650
18651 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18652 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018653 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018654
18655 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018656 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018657 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18658 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18659 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18660 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18661 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018662
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018663
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200186649. Supported filters
18665--------------------
18666
18667Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18668accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18669unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18670
18671See also : "filter"
18672
186739.1. Trace
18674----------
18675
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018676filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018677
18678 Arguments:
18679 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18680 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18681
18682 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18683 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18684 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18685 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18686
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018687 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018688 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18689 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18690 amount of the parsed data.
18691
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018692 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018693
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018694This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18695callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18696information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18697filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18698
18699Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18700tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18701a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18702
18703
187049.2. HTTP compression
18705---------------------
18706
18707filter compression
18708
18709The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18710keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018711when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18712fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18713done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18714explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18715filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18716listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18717order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018718
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018719See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18720 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018721
18722
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200187239.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18724--------------------------------------------
18725
18726filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18727
18728 Arguments :
18729
18730 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18731 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18732 parsed.
18733
18734 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18735 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18736 part must be placed in its own scope.
18737
18738The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18739external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018740streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018741exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18742also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18743
18744SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18745the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18746
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018747For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018748"doc/SPOE.txt".
18749
18750Important note:
18751 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18752 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18753
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100187549.4. Cache
18755----------
18756
18757filter cache <name>
18758
18759 Arguments :
18760
18761 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18762
18763The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18764"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018765cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018766other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18767case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18768is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18769filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018770listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18771order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018772
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018773See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18774 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18775
18776
187779.5. Fcgi-app
18778-------------
18779
18780filter fcg-app <name>
18781
18782 Arguments :
18783
18784 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18785
18786The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18787request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18788reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18789used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18790implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18791used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18792fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18793used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18794order.
18795
18796See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18797 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18798
18799
1880010. FastCGI applications
18801-------------------------
18802
18803HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18804feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18805the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18806FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18807servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18808FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18809backend.
18810
18811HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18812application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18813connection.
18814
1881510.1. Setup
18816-----------
18817
1881810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18819--------------------------
18820
18821fcgi-app <name>
18822 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18823 document root must be defined.
18824
18825acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18826 Declare or complete an access list.
18827
18828 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18829 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18830 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18831 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18832 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18833
18834docroot <path>
18835 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18836 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18837 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18838
18839index <script-name>
18840 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18841 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18842 is an optional setting.
18843
18844 Example :
18845 index index.php
18846
18847log-stderr global
18848log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18849 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18850 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18851
18852 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18853 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18854
18855pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18856 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18857 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18858 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18859
18860 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18861 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18862 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18863 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18864
18865 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18866 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18867
18868path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018869 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018870 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
18871 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
18872 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
18873 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
18874 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18875 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
18876 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018877
18878 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018879 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018880 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
18881 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
18882 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
18883 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018884
18885 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018886 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
18887 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018888
18889option get-values
18890no option get-values
18891 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18892
18893 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18894 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18895
18896 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18897 application will accept.
18898
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018899 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18900 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018901
18902 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18903 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18904 option is disabled.
18905
18906 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18907 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18908 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18909 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18910 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18911 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18912
18913option keep-conn
18914no option keep-conn
18915 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18916 sending a response.
18917
18918 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18919 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18920
18921option max-reqs <reqs>
18922 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18923 accept.
18924
18925 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18926 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18927 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18928 to 1.
18929
18930option mpxs-conns
18931no option mpxs-conns
18932 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18933
18934 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18935 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18936
18937set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18938 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18939 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18940 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18941 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18942
18943 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18944 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18945 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18946
18947 Example :
18948 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18949 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18950
18951 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18952
18953
1895410.1.2. Proxy section
18955---------------------
18956
18957use-fcgi-app <name>
18958 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18959
18960 Arguments :
18961 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18962
18963 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18964 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18965 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18966 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18967 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18968
18969 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18970 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18971 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18972 application are evaluated.
18973
18974
1897510.1.3. Example
18976---------------
18977
18978 frontend front-http
18979 mode http
18980 bind *:80
18981 bind *:
18982
18983 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18984 default_backend back-static
18985
18986 backend back-static
18987 mode http
18988 server www A.B.C.D:80
18989
18990 backend back-dynamic
18991 mode http
18992 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18993 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18994
18995 fcgi-app php-fpm
18996 log-stderr global
18997 option keep-conn
18998
18999 docroot /var/www/my-app
19000 index index.php
19001 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19002
19003
1900410.2. Default parameters
19005------------------------
19006
19007A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19008the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019009script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019010applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19011
19012 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19013 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19014 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19015 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19016 | | |
19017 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19018 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19019 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19020 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19021 | | application. |
19022 | | |
19023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19024 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19025 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19026 | | |
19027 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19028 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19029 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19030 | | the application's configuration. |
19031 | | |
19032 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19033 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19034 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19035 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19036 | | |
19037 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19038 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19039 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19040 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19041 | | be defined. |
19042 | | |
19043 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19044 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19045 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19046 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19047 | | is not set too. |
19048 | | |
19049 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19050 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19051 | | set. |
19052 | | |
19053 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19054 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19055 | | the request. |
19056 | | |
19057 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19058 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19059 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19060 | | |
19061 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19062 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19063 | | script to process the request. |
19064 | | |
19065 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19066 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19067 | | |
19068 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19069 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19070 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19071 | | |
19072 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19073 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19074 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19075 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19076 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19077 | | |
19078 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19079 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19080 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19081 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19082 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19083 | | side. |
19084 | | |
19085 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19086 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19087 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19088 | | connected to. |
19089 | | |
19090 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19091 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19092 | | |
19093 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19094 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19095 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19096 | | |
19097 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19098
19099
1910010.3. Limitations
19101------------------
19102
19103The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19104way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19105during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19106establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19107application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19108or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19109message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19110these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19111and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19112
19113Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19114request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19115requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19116
19117About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19118into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19119fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19120"http-request" ones.
19121
19122Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19123FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19124processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19125must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19126here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019128/*
19129 * Local variables:
19130 * fill-column: 79
19131 * End:
19132 */